Using /etc/X11 for configuration is allowed, not should
[debian-policy.git] / policy.sgml
blob0eed329890f79073e3d278e4fc44c48318506eae
1 <!doctype debiandoc system [
2 <!-- include version information so we don't have to hard code it
3 within the document -->
4 <!entity % versiondata SYSTEM "version.ent"> %versiondata;
5 ]>
6 <debiandoc>
8 <book>
9 <titlepag>
10 <title>Debian Policy Manual</title>
11 <author><qref id="authors">The Debian Policy Mailing List</qref></author>
12 <version>version &version;, &date;</version>
14 <abstract>
15 This manual describes the policy requirements for the Debian
16 GNU/Linux distribution. This includes the structure and
17 contents of the Debian archive and several design issues of
18 the operating system, as well as technical requirements that
19 each package must satisfy to be included in the distribution.
20 </abstract>
22 <copyright>
23 <copyrightsummary>
24 Copyright &copy; 1996,1997,1998 Ian Jackson
25 and Christian Schwarz.
26 </copyrightsummary>
27 <p>
28 These are the copyright dates of the original Policy manual.
29 Since then, this manual has been updated by many others. No
30 comprehensive collection of copyright notices for subsequent
31 work exists.
32 </p>
34 <p>
35 This manual is free software; you may redistribute it and/or
36 modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
37 as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version
38 2, or (at your option) any later version.
39 </p>
41 <p>
42 This is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
43 <em>without any warranty</em>; without even the implied
44 warranty of merchantability or fitness for a particular
45 purpose. See the GNU General Public License for more
46 details.
47 </p>
49 <p>
50 A copy of the GNU General Public License is available as
51 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL</file> in the Debian GNU/Linux
52 distribution or on the World Wide Web at
53 <url id="http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/gpl.html"
54 name="the GNU General Public Licence">. You can also
55 obtain it by writing to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
56 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
57 </p>
58 </copyright>
59 </titlepag>
61 <toc detail="sect1">
63 <chapt id="scope">
64 <heading>About this manual</heading>
65 <sect>
66 <heading>Scope</heading>
67 <p>
68 This manual describes the policy requirements for the Debian
69 GNU/Linux distribution. This includes the structure and
70 contents of the Debian archive and several design issues of the
71 operating system, as well as technical requirements that
72 each package must satisfy to be included in the
73 distribution.
74 </p>
76 <p>
77 This manual also describes Debian policy as it relates to
78 creating Debian packages. It is not a tutorial on how to build
79 packages, nor is it exhaustive where it comes to describing
80 the behavior of the packaging system. Instead, this manual
81 attempts to define the interface to the package management
82 system that the developers have to be conversant with.<footnote>
83 Informally, the criteria used for inclusion is that the
84 material meet one of the following requirements:
85 <taglist compact="compact">
86 <tag>Standard interfaces</tag>
87 <item>
88 The material presented represents an interface to
89 the packaging system that is mandated for use, and
90 is used by, a significant number of packages, and
91 therefore should not be changed without peer
92 review. Package maintainers can then rely on this
93 interfaces not changing, and the package
94 management software authors need to ensure
95 compatibility with these interface
96 definitions. (Control file and changelog file
97 formats are examples.)
98 </item>
99 <tag>Chosen Convention</tag>
100 <item>
101 If there are a number of technically viable choices
102 that can be made, but one needs to select one of
103 these options for inter-operability. The version
104 number format is one example.
105 </item>
106 </taglist>
107 Please note that these are not mutually exclusive;
108 selected conventions often become parts of standard
109 interfaces.
110 </footnote>
111 </p>
114 The footnotes present in this manual are
115 merely informative, and are not part of Debian policy itself.
116 </p>
119 The appendices to this manual are not necessarily normative,
120 either. Please see <ref id="pkg-scope"> for more information.
121 </p>
124 In the normative part of this manual,
125 the words <em>must</em>, <em>should</em> and
126 <em>may</em>, and the adjectives <em>required</em>,
127 <em>recommended</em> and <em>optional</em>, are used to
128 distinguish the significance of the various guidelines in
129 this policy document. Packages that do not conform to the
130 guidelines denoted by <em>must</em> (or <em>required</em>)
131 will generally not be considered acceptable for the Debian
132 distribution. Non-conformance with guidelines denoted by
133 <em>should</em> (or <em>recommended</em>) will generally be
134 considered a bug, but will not necessarily render a package
135 unsuitable for distribution. Guidelines denoted by
136 <em>may</em> (or <em>optional</em>) are truly optional and
137 adherence is left to the maintainer's discretion.
138 </p>
141 These classifications are roughly equivalent to the bug
142 severities <em>serious</em> (for <em>must</em> or
143 <em>required</em> directive violations), <em>minor</em>,
144 <em>normal</em> or <em>important</em>
145 (for <em>should</em> or <em>recommended</em> directive
146 violations) and <em>wishlist</em> (for <em>optional</em>
147 items).
148 <footnote>
149 Compare RFC 2119. Note, however, that these words are
150 used in a different way in this document.
151 </footnote>
152 </p>
155 Much of the information presented in this manual will be
156 useful even when building a package which is to be
157 distributed in some other way or is intended for local use
158 only.
159 </p>
160 </sect>
162 <sect>
163 <heading>New versions of this document</heading>
166 This manual is distributed via the Debian package
167 <package><url name="debian-policy"
168 id="http://packages.debian.org/debian-policy"></package>
169 (<httpsite>packages.debian.org</httpsite>
170 <httppath>/debian-policy</httppath>).
171 </p>
174 The current version of this document is also available from
175 the Debian web mirrors at
176 <tt><url name="/doc/debian-policy/"
177 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/"></tt>.
179 <httpsite>www.debian.org</httpsite>
180 <httppath>/doc/debian-policy/</httppath>)
181 Also available from the same directory are several other
182 formats: <file>policy.html.tar.gz</file>
183 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.html.tar.gz</httppath>),
184 <file>policy.pdf.gz</file>
185 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.pdf.gz</httppath>)
186 and <file>policy.ps.gz</file>
187 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.ps.gz</httppath>).
188 </p>
191 The <package>debian-policy</package> package also includes the file
192 <file>upgrading-checklist.txt.gz</file> which indicates policy
193 changes between versions of this document.
194 </p>
195 </sect>
197 <sect id="authors">
198 <heading>Authors and Maintainers</heading>
201 Originally called "Debian GNU/Linux Policy Manual", this
202 manual was initially written in 1996 by Ian Jackson.
203 It was revised on November 27th, 1996 by David A. Morris.
204 Christian Schwarz added new sections on March 15th, 1997,
205 and reworked/restructured it in April-July 1997.
206 Christoph Lameter contributed the "Web Standard".
207 Julian Gilbey largely restructured it in 2001.
208 </p>
211 Since September 1998, the responsibility for the contents of
212 this document lies on the <url name="debian-policy mailing list"
213 id="mailto:debian-policy@lists.debian.org">. Proposals
214 are discussed there and inserted into policy after a certain
215 consensus is established.
216 <!-- insert shameless policy-process plug here eventually -->
217 The actual editing is done by a group of maintainers that have
218 no editorial powers. These are the current maintainers:
220 <enumlist>
221 <item>Julian Gilbey</item>
222 <item>Branden Robinson</item>
223 <item>Josip Rodin</item>
224 <item>Manoj Srivastava</item>
225 </enumlist>
226 </p>
229 While the authors of this document have tried hard to avoid
230 typos and other errors, these do still occur. If you discover
231 an error in this manual or if you want to give any
232 comments, suggestions, or criticisms please send an email to
233 the Debian Policy List,
234 <email>debian-policy@lists.debian.org</email>, or submit a
235 bug report against the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
236 </p>
239 Please do not try to reach the individual authors or maintainers
240 of the Policy Manual regarding changes to the Policy.
241 </p>
242 </sect>
244 <sect id="related">
245 <heading>Related documents</heading>
248 There are several other documents other than this Policy Manual
249 that are necessary to fully understand some Debian policies and
250 procedures.
251 </p>
254 The external "sub-policy" documents are referred to in:
255 <list compact="compact">
256 <item><ref id="fhs"></item>
257 <item><ref id="virtual_pkg"></item>
258 <item><ref id="menus"></item>
259 <item><ref id="mime"></item>
260 <item><ref id="perl"></item>
261 <item><ref id="maintscriptprompt"></item>
262 <item><ref id="emacs"></item>
263 </list>
264 </p>
267 In addition to those, which carry the weight of policy, there
268 is the Debian Developer's Reference. This document describes
269 procedures and resources for Debian developers, but it is
270 <em>not</em> normative; rather, it includes things that don't
271 belong in the Policy, such as best practices for developers.
272 </p>
275 The Developer's Reference is available in the
276 <package>developers-reference</package> package.
277 It's also available from the Debian web mirrors at
278 <tt><url name="/doc/developers-reference/"
279 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/developers-reference/"></tt>.
280 </p>
281 </sect>
283 <sect id="definitions">
284 <heading>Definitions</heading>
287 The following terms are used in this Policy Manual:
288 <taglist>
289 <tag>ASCII</tag>
290 <item>
291 The character encoding specified by ANSI X3.4-1986 and its
292 predecessor standards, referred to in MIME as US-ASCII, and
293 corresponding to an encoding in eight bits per character of
294 the first 128 <url id="http://www.unicode.org/"
295 name="Unicode"> characters, with the eighth bit always zero.
296 </item>
297 <tag>UTF-8</tag>
298 <item>
299 The transformation format (sometimes called encoding) of
300 <url id="http://www.unicode.org/" name="Unicode"> defined by
301 <url id="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3629.txt"
302 name="RFC 3629">. UTF-8 has the useful property of having
303 ASCII as a subset, so any text encoded in ASCII is trivially
304 also valid UTF-8.
305 </item>
306 </taglist>
307 </p>
308 </sect>
309 </chapt>
312 <chapt id="archive">
313 <heading>The Debian Archive</heading>
316 The Debian GNU/Linux system is maintained and distributed as a
317 collection of <em>packages</em>. Since there are so many of
318 them (currently well over 15000), they are split into
319 <em>sections</em> and given <em>priorities</em> to simplify
320 the handling of them.
321 </p>
324 The effort of the Debian project is to build a free operating
325 system, but not every package we want to make accessible is
326 <em>free</em> in our sense (see the Debian Free Software
327 Guidelines, below), or may be imported/exported without
328 restrictions. Thus, the archive is split into areas<footnote>
329 The Debian archive software uses the term "component" internally
330 and in the Release file format to refer to the division of an
331 archive. The Debian Social Contract simply refers to "areas."
332 This document uses terminology similar to the Social Contract.
333 </footnote> based on their licenses and other restrictions.
334 </p>
337 The aims of this are:
339 <list compact="compact">
340 <item>to allow us to make as much software available as we can</item>
341 <item>to allow us to encourage everyone to write free software,
342 and</item>
343 <item>to allow us to make it easy for people to produce
344 CD-ROMs of our system without violating any licenses,
345 import/export restrictions, or any other laws.</item>
346 </list>
347 </p>
350 The <em>main</em> archive area forms the <em>Debian GNU/Linux
351 distribution</em>.
352 </p>
355 Packages in the other archive areas (<tt>contrib</tt>,
356 <tt>non-free</tt>) are not considered to be part of the Debian
357 distribution, although we support their use and provide
358 infrastructure for them (such as our bug-tracking system and
359 mailing lists). This Debian Policy Manual applies to these
360 packages as well.
361 </p>
363 <sect id="dfsg">
364 <heading>The Debian Free Software Guidelines</heading>
366 The Debian Free Software Guidelines (DFSG) form our
367 definition of "free software". These are:
368 <taglist>
369 <tag>Free Redistribution
370 </tag>
371 <item>
372 The license of a Debian component may not restrict any
373 party from selling or giving away the software as a
374 component of an aggregate software distribution
375 containing programs from several different
376 sources. The license may not require a royalty or
377 other fee for such sale.
378 </item>
379 <tag>Source Code
380 </tag>
381 <item>
382 The program must include source code, and must allow
383 distribution in source code as well as compiled form.
384 </item>
385 <tag>Derived Works
386 </tag>
387 <item>
388 The license must allow modifications and derived
389 works, and must allow them to be distributed under the
390 same terms as the license of the original software.
391 </item>
392 <tag>Integrity of The Author's Source Code
393 </tag>
394 <item>
395 The license may restrict source-code from being
396 distributed in modified form <em>only</em> if the
397 license allows the distribution of "patch files"
398 with the source code for the purpose of modifying the
399 program at build time. The license must explicitly
400 permit distribution of software built from modified
401 source code. The license may require derived works to
402 carry a different name or version number from the
403 original software. (This is a compromise. The Debian
404 Project encourages all authors to not restrict any
405 files, source or binary, from being modified.)
406 </item>
407 <tag>No Discrimination Against Persons or Groups
408 </tag>
409 <item>
410 The license must not discriminate against any person
411 or group of persons.
412 </item>
413 <tag>No Discrimination Against Fields of Endeavor
414 </tag>
415 <item>
416 The license must not restrict anyone from making use
417 of the program in a specific field of endeavor. For
418 example, it may not restrict the program from being
419 used in a business, or from being used for genetic
420 research.
421 </item>
422 <tag>Distribution of License
423 </tag>
424 <item>
425 The rights attached to the program must apply to all
426 to whom the program is redistributed without the need
427 for execution of an additional license by those
428 parties.
429 </item>
430 <tag>License Must Not Be Specific to Debian
431 </tag>
432 <item>
433 The rights attached to the program must not depend on
434 the program's being part of a Debian system. If the
435 program is extracted from Debian and used or
436 distributed without Debian but otherwise within the
437 terms of the program's license, all parties to whom
438 the program is redistributed must have the same
439 rights as those that are granted in conjunction with
440 the Debian system.
441 </item>
442 <tag>License Must Not Contaminate Other Software
443 </tag>
444 <item>
445 The license must not place restrictions on other
446 software that is distributed along with the licensed
447 software. For example, the license must not insist
448 that all other programs distributed on the same medium
449 must be free software.
450 </item>
451 <tag>Example Licenses
452 </tag>
453 <item>
454 The "GPL," "BSD," and "Artistic" licenses are examples of
455 licenses that we consider <em>free</em>.
456 </item>
457 </taglist>
458 </p>
459 </sect>
461 <sect id="sections">
462 <heading>Archive areas</heading>
464 <sect1 id="main">
465 <heading>The main archive area</heading>
468 Every package in <em>main</em> must comply with the DFSG
469 (Debian Free Software Guidelines).
470 </p>
473 In addition, the packages in <em>main</em>
474 <list compact="compact">
475 <item>
476 must not require a package outside of <em>main</em>
477 for compilation or execution (thus, the package must
478 not declare a "Depends", "Recommends", or
479 "Build-Depends" relationship on a non-<em>main</em>
480 package),
481 </item>
482 <item>
483 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
485 </item>
486 <item>
487 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
488 manual.
489 </item>
490 </list>
491 </p>
493 </sect1>
495 <sect1 id="contrib">
496 <heading>The contrib archive area</heading>
499 Every package in <em>contrib</em> must comply with the DFSG.
500 </p>
503 In addition, the packages in <em>contrib</em>
504 <list compact="compact">
505 <item>
506 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
508 </item>
509 <item>
510 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
511 manual.
512 </item>
513 </list>
514 </p>
518 Examples of packages which would be included in
519 <em>contrib</em> are:
520 <list compact="compact">
521 <item>
522 free packages which require <em>contrib</em>,
523 <em>non-free</em> packages or packages which are not
524 in our archive at all for compilation or execution,
526 </item>
527 <item>
528 wrapper packages or other sorts of free accessories for
529 non-free programs.
530 </item>
531 </list>
532 </p>
533 </sect1>
535 <sect1 id="non-free">
536 <heading>The non-free archive area</heading>
539 Packages must be placed in <em>non-free</em> if they are
540 not compliant with the DFSG or are encumbered by patents
541 or other legal issues that make their distribution
542 problematic.
543 </p>
546 In addition, the packages in <em>non-free</em>
547 <list compact="compact">
548 <item>
549 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
551 </item>
552 <item>
553 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
554 manual that it is possible for them to meet.
555 <footnote>
556 It is possible that there are policy
557 requirements which the package is unable to
558 meet, for example, if the source is
559 unavailable. These situations will need to be
560 handled on a case-by-case basis.
561 </footnote>
562 </item>
563 </list>
564 </p>
565 </sect1>
567 </sect>
569 <sect id="pkgcopyright">
570 <heading>Copyright considerations</heading>
573 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of
574 its copyright and distribution license in the file
575 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>
576 (see <ref id="copyrightfile"> for further details).
577 </p>
580 We reserve the right to restrict files from being included
581 anywhere in our archives if
582 <list compact="compact">
583 <item>
584 their use or distribution would break a law,
585 </item>
586 <item>
587 there is an ethical conflict in their distribution or
588 use,
589 </item>
590 <item>
591 we would have to sign a license for them, or
592 </item>
593 <item>
594 their distribution would conflict with other project
595 policies.
596 </item>
597 </list>
598 </p>
601 Programs whose authors encourage the user to make
602 donations are fine for the main distribution, provided
603 that the authors do not claim that not donating is
604 immoral, unethical, illegal or something similar; in such
605 a case they must go in <em>non-free</em>.
606 </p>
609 Packages whose copyright permission notices (or patent
610 problems) do not even allow redistribution of binaries
611 only, and where no special permission has been obtained,
612 must not be placed on the Debian FTP site and its mirrors
613 at all.
614 </p>
617 Note that under international copyright law (this applies
618 in the United States, too), <em>no</em> distribution or
619 modification of a work is allowed without an explicit
620 notice saying so. Therefore a program without a copyright
621 notice <em>is</em> copyrighted and you may not do anything
622 to it without risking being sued! Likewise if a program
623 has a copyright notice but no statement saying what is
624 permitted then nothing is permitted.
625 </p>
628 Many authors are unaware of the problems that restrictive
629 copyrights (or lack of copyright notices) can cause for
630 the users of their supposedly-free software. It is often
631 worthwhile contacting such authors diplomatically to ask
632 them to modify their license terms. However, this can be a
633 politically difficult thing to do and you should ask for
634 advice on the <tt>debian-legal</tt> mailing list first, as
635 explained below.
636 </p>
639 When in doubt about a copyright, send mail to
640 <email>debian-legal@lists.debian.org</email>. Be prepared
641 to provide us with the copyright statement. Software
642 covered by the GPL, public domain software and BSD-like
643 copyrights are safe; be wary of the phrases "commercial
644 use prohibited" and "distribution restricted".
645 </p>
646 </sect>
648 <sect id="subsections">
649 <heading>Sections</heading>
652 The packages in the archive areas <em>main</em>,
653 <em>contrib</em> and <em>non-free</em> are grouped further into
654 <em>sections</em> to simplify handling.
655 </p>
658 The archive area and section for each package should be
659 specified in the package's <tt>Section</tt> control record (see
660 <ref id="f-Section">). However, the maintainer of the Debian
661 archive may override this selection to ensure the consistency of
662 the Debian distribution. The <tt>Section</tt> field should be
663 of the form:
664 <list compact="compact">
665 <item>
666 <em>section</em> if the package is in the
667 <em>main</em> archive area,
668 </item>
669 <item>
670 <em>area/section</em> if the package is in
671 the <em>contrib</em> or <em>non-free</em>
672 archive areas.
673 </item>
674 </list>
675 </p>
678 The Debian archive maintainers provide the authoritative
679 list of sections. At present, they are:
680 <em>admin</em>, <em>cli-mono</em>, <em>comm</em>, <em>database</em>,
681 <em>devel</em>, <em>debug</em>, <em>doc</em>, <em>editors</em>,
682 <em>electronics</em>, <em>embedded</em>, <em>fonts</em>,
683 <em>games</em>, <em>gnome</em>, <em>graphics</em>, <em>gnu-r</em>,
684 <em>gnustep</em>, <em>hamradio</em>, <em>haskell</em>,
685 <em>httpd</em>, <em>interpreters</em>, <em>java</em>, <em>kde</em>,
686 <em>kernel</em>, <em>libs</em>, <em>libdevel</em>, <em>lisp</em>,
687 <em>localization</em>, <em>mail</em>, <em>math</em>, <em>misc</em>,
688 <em>net</em>, <em>news</em>, <em>ocaml</em>, <em>oldlibs</em>,
689 <em>otherosfs</em>, <em>perl</em>, <em>php</em>, <em>python</em>,
690 <em>ruby</em>, <em>science</em>, <em>shells</em>, <em>sound</em>,
691 <em>tex</em>, <em>text</em>, <em>utils</em>, <em>vcs</em>,
692 <em>video</em>, <em>web</em>, <em>x11</em>, <em>xfce</em>,
693 <em>zope</em>.
694 </p>
695 </sect>
697 <sect id="priorities">
698 <heading>Priorities</heading>
701 Each package should have a <em>priority</em> value, which is
702 included in the package's <em>control record</em>
703 (see <ref id="f-Priority">).
704 This information is used by the Debian package management tools to
705 separate high-priority packages from less-important packages.
706 </p>
709 The following <em>priority levels</em> are recognized by the
710 Debian package management tools.
711 <taglist>
712 <tag><tt>required</tt></tag>
713 <item>
714 Packages which are necessary for the proper
715 functioning of the system (usually, this means that
716 dpkg functionality depends on these packages).
717 Removing a <tt>required</tt> package may cause your
718 system to become totally broken and you may not even
719 be able to use <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to put things back,
720 so only do so if you know what you are doing. Systems
721 with only the <tt>required</tt> packages are probably
722 unusable, but they do have enough functionality to
723 allow the sysadmin to boot and install more software.
724 </item>
725 <tag><tt>important</tt></tag>
726 <item>
727 Important programs, including those which one would
728 expect to find on any Unix-like system. If the
729 expectation is that an experienced Unix person who
730 found it missing would say "What on earth is going on,
731 where is <prgn>foo</prgn>?", it must be an
732 <tt>important</tt> package.<footnote>
733 This is an important criterion because we are
734 trying to produce, amongst other things, a free
735 Unix.
736 </footnote>
737 Other packages without which the system will not run
738 well or be usable must also have priority
739 <tt>important</tt>. This does
740 <em>not</em> include Emacs, the X Window System, TeX
741 or any other large applications. The
742 <tt>important</tt> packages are just a bare minimum of
743 commonly-expected and necessary tools.
744 </item>
745 <tag><tt>standard</tt></tag>
746 <item>
747 These packages provide a reasonably small but not too
748 limited character-mode system. This is what will be
749 installed by default if the user doesn't select anything
750 else. It doesn't include many large applications.
751 </item>
752 <tag><tt>optional</tt></tag>
753 <item>
754 (In a sense everything that isn't required is
755 optional, but that's not what is meant here.) This is
756 all the software that you might reasonably want to
757 install if you didn't know what it was and don't have
758 specialized requirements. This is a much larger system
759 and includes the X Window System, a full TeX
760 distribution, and many applications. Note that
761 optional packages should not conflict with each other.
762 </item>
763 <tag><tt>extra</tt></tag>
764 <item>
765 This contains all packages that conflict with others
766 with required, important, standard or optional
767 priorities, or are only likely to be useful if you
768 already know what they are or have specialized
769 requirements (such as packages containing only detached
770 debugging symbols).
771 </item>
772 </taglist>
773 </p>
776 Packages must not depend on packages with lower priority
777 values (excluding build-time dependencies). In order to
778 ensure this, the priorities of one or more packages may need
779 to be adjusted.
780 </p>
781 </sect>
783 </chapt>
786 <chapt id="binary">
787 <heading>Binary packages</heading>
790 The Debian GNU/Linux distribution is based on the Debian
791 package management system, called <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. Thus,
792 all packages in the Debian distribution must be provided
793 in the <tt>.deb</tt> file format.
794 </p>
796 <sect>
797 <heading>The package name</heading>
800 Every package must have a name that's unique within the Debian
801 archive.
802 </p>
805 The package name is included in the control field
806 <tt>Package</tt>, the format of which is described
807 in <ref id="f-Package">.
808 The package name is also included as a part of the file name
809 of the <tt>.deb</tt> file.
810 </p>
811 </sect>
813 <sect id="versions">
814 <heading>The version of a package</heading>
817 Every package has a version number recorded in its
818 <tt>Version</tt> control file field, described in
819 <ref id="f-Version">.
820 </p>
823 The package management system imposes an ordering on version
824 numbers, so that it can tell whether packages are being up- or
825 downgraded and so that package system front end applications
826 can tell whether a package it finds available is newer than
827 the one installed on the system. The version number format
828 has the most significant parts (as far as comparison is
829 concerned) at the beginning.
830 </p>
833 If an upstream package has problematic version numbers they
834 should be converted to a sane form for use in the
835 <tt>Version</tt> field.
836 </p>
838 <sect1>
839 <heading>Version numbers based on dates</heading>
842 In general, Debian packages should use the same version
843 numbers as the upstream sources.
844 </p>
847 However, in some cases where the upstream version number is
848 based on a date (e.g., a development "snapshot" release) the
849 package management system cannot handle these version
850 numbers without epochs. For example, dpkg will consider
851 "96May01" to be greater than "96Dec24".
852 </p>
855 To prevent having to use epochs for every new upstream
856 version, the date based portion of the version number
857 should be changed to the following format in such cases:
858 "19960501", "19961224". It is up to the maintainer whether
859 they want to bother the upstream maintainer to change
860 the version numbers upstream, too.
861 </p>
864 Note that other version formats based on dates which are
865 parsed correctly by the package management system should
866 <em>not</em> be changed.
867 </p>
870 Native Debian packages (i.e., packages which have been
871 written especially for Debian) whose version numbers include
872 dates should always use the "YYYYMMDD" format.
873 </p>
874 </sect1>
876 </sect>
878 <sect>
879 <heading>The maintainer of a package</heading>
882 Every package must have a Debian maintainer (the
883 maintainer may be one person or a group of people
884 reachable from a common email address, such as a mailing
885 list). The maintainer is responsible for ensuring that
886 the package is placed in the appropriate distributions.
887 </p>
890 The maintainer must be specified in the
891 <tt>Maintainer</tt> control field with their correct name
892 and a working email address. If one person maintains
893 several packages, they should try to avoid having
894 different forms of their name and email address in
895 the <tt>Maintainer</tt> fields of those packages.
896 </p>
899 The format of the <tt>Maintainer</tt> control field is
900 described in <ref id="f-Maintainer">.
901 </p>
904 If the maintainer of a package quits from the Debian
905 project, "Debian QA Group"
906 <email>packages@qa.debian.org</email> takes over the
907 maintainer-ship of the package until someone else
908 volunteers for that task. These packages are called
909 <em>orphaned packages</em>.<footnote>
910 The detailed procedure for doing this gracefully can
911 be found in the Debian Developer's Reference,
912 see <ref id="related">.
913 </footnote>
914 </p>
915 </sect>
917 <sect id="descriptions">
918 <heading>The description of a package</heading>
921 Every Debian package must have an extended description
922 stored in the appropriate field of the control record.
923 The technical information about the format of the
924 <tt>Description</tt> field is in <ref id="f-Description">.
925 </p>
928 The description should describe the package (the program) to a
929 user (system administrator) who has never met it before so that
930 they have enough information to decide whether they want to
931 install it. This description should not just be copied verbatim
932 from the program's documentation.
933 </p>
936 Put important information first, both in the synopsis and
937 extended description. Sometimes only the first part of the
938 synopsis or of the description will be displayed. You can
939 assume that there will usually be a way to see the whole
940 extended description.
941 </p>
944 The description should also give information about the
945 significant dependencies and conflicts between this package
946 and others, so that the user knows why these dependencies and
947 conflicts have been declared.
948 </p>
951 Instructions for configuring or using the package should
952 not be included (that is what installation scripts,
953 manual pages, info files, etc., are for). Copyright
954 statements and other administrivia should not be included
955 either (that is what the copyright file is for).
956 </p>
958 <sect1 id="synopsis"><heading>The single line synopsis</heading>
961 The single line synopsis should be kept brief - certainly
962 under 80 characters.
963 </p>
966 Do not include the package name in the synopsis line. The
967 display software knows how to display this already, and you
968 do not need to state it. Remember that in many situations
969 the user may only see the synopsis line - make it as
970 informative as you can.
971 </p>
973 </sect1>
975 <sect1 id="extendeddesc"><heading>The extended description</heading>
978 Do not try to continue the single line synopsis into the
979 extended description. This will not work correctly when
980 the full description is displayed, and makes no sense
981 where only the summary (the single line synopsis) is
982 available.
983 </p>
986 The extended description should describe what the package
987 does and how it relates to the rest of the system (in terms
988 of, for example, which subsystem it is which part of).
989 </p>
992 The description field needs to make sense to anyone, even
993 people who have no idea about any of the things the
994 package deals with.<footnote>
995 The blurb that comes with a program in its
996 announcements and/or <prgn>README</prgn> files is
997 rarely suitable for use in a description. It is
998 usually aimed at people who are already in the
999 community where the package is used.
1000 </footnote>
1001 </p>
1003 </sect1>
1005 </sect>
1007 <sect>
1008 <heading>Dependencies</heading>
1011 Every package must specify the dependency information
1012 about other packages that are required for the first to
1013 work correctly.
1014 </p>
1017 For example, a dependency entry must be provided for any
1018 shared libraries required by a dynamically-linked executable
1019 binary in a package.
1020 </p>
1023 Packages are not required to declare any dependencies they
1024 have on other packages which are marked <tt>Essential</tt>
1025 (see below), and should not do so unless they depend on a
1026 particular version of that package.<footnote>
1028 Essential is needed in part to avoid unresolvable dependency
1029 loops on upgrade. If packages add unnecessary dependencies
1030 on packages in this set, the chances that there
1031 <strong>will</strong> be an unresolvable dependency loop
1032 caused by forcing these Essential packages to be configured
1033 first before they need to be is greatly increased. It also
1034 increases the chances that frontends will be unable to
1035 <strong>calculate</strong> an upgrade path, even if one
1036 exists.
1037 </p>
1039 Also, functionality is rarely ever removed from the
1040 Essential set, but <em>packages</em> have been removed from
1041 the Essential set when the functionality moved to a
1042 different package. So depending on these packages <em>just
1043 in case</em> they stop being essential does way more harm
1044 than good.
1045 </p>
1046 </footnote>
1047 </p>
1050 Sometimes, a package requires another package to be installed
1051 <em>and</em> configured before it can be installed. In this
1052 case, you must specify a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> entry for
1053 the package.
1054 </p>
1057 You should not specify a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> entry for a
1058 package before this has been discussed on the
1059 <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list and a consensus about
1060 doing that has been reached.
1061 </p>
1064 The format of the package interrelationship control fields is
1065 described in <ref id="relationships">.
1066 </p>
1067 </sect>
1069 <sect id="virtual_pkg">
1070 <heading>Virtual packages</heading>
1073 Sometimes, there are several packages which offer
1074 more-or-less the same functionality. In this case, it's
1075 useful to define a <em>virtual package</em> whose name
1076 describes that common functionality. (The virtual
1077 packages only exist logically, not physically; that's why
1078 they are called <em>virtual</em>.) The packages with this
1079 particular function will then <em>provide</em> the virtual
1080 package. Thus, any other package requiring that function
1081 can simply depend on the virtual package without having to
1082 specify all possible packages individually.
1083 </p>
1086 All packages should use virtual package names where
1087 appropriate, and arrange to create new ones if necessary.
1088 They should not use virtual package names (except privately,
1089 amongst a cooperating group of packages) unless they have
1090 been agreed upon and appear in the list of virtual package
1091 names. (See also <ref id="virtual">)
1092 </p>
1095 The latest version of the authoritative list of virtual
1096 package names can be found in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
1097 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
1098 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/virtual-package-names-list.txt"
1099 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/virtual-package-names-list.txt"></tt>.
1100 </p>
1103 The procedure for updating the list is described in the preface
1104 to the list.
1105 </p>
1107 </sect>
1109 <sect>
1110 <heading>Base system</heading>
1113 The <tt>base system</tt> is a minimum subset of the Debian
1114 GNU/Linux system that is installed before everything else
1115 on a new system. Only very few packages are allowed to form
1116 part of the base system, in order to keep the required disk
1117 usage very small.
1118 </p>
1121 The base system consists of all those packages with priority
1122 <tt>required</tt> or <tt>important</tt>. Many of them will
1123 be tagged <tt>essential</tt> (see below).
1124 </p>
1125 </sect>
1127 <sect>
1128 <heading>Essential packages</heading>
1131 Essential is defined as the minimal set of functionality that
1132 must be available and usable on the system at all times, even
1133 when packages are in an unconfigured (but unpacked) state.
1134 Packages are tagged <tt>essential</tt> for a system using the
1135 <tt>Essential</tt> control file field. The format of the
1136 <tt>Essential</tt> control field is described in <ref
1137 id="f-Essential">.
1138 </p>
1141 Since these packages cannot be easily removed (one has to
1142 specify an extra <em>force option</em> to
1143 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to do so), this flag must not be used
1144 unless absolutely necessary. A shared library package
1145 must not be tagged <tt>essential</tt>; dependencies will
1146 prevent its premature removal, and we need to be able to
1147 remove it when it has been superseded.
1148 </p>
1151 Since dpkg will not prevent upgrading of other packages
1152 while an <tt>essential</tt> package is in an unconfigured
1153 state, all <tt>essential</tt> packages must supply all of
1154 their core functionality even when unconfigured. If the
1155 package cannot satisfy this requirement it must not be
1156 tagged as essential, and any packages depending on this
1157 package must instead have explicit dependency fields as
1158 appropriate.
1159 </p>
1162 Maintainers should take great care in adding any programs,
1163 interfaces, or functionality to <tt>essential</tt> packages.
1164 Packages may assume that functionality provided by
1165 <tt>essential</tt> packages is always available without
1166 declaring explicit dependencies, which means that removing
1167 functionality from the Essential set is very difficult and is
1168 almost never done. Any capability added to an
1169 <tt>essential</tt> package therefore creates an obligation to
1170 support that capability as part of the Essential set in
1171 perpetuity.
1172 </p>
1175 You must not tag any packages <tt>essential</tt> before
1176 this has been discussed on the <tt>debian-devel</tt>
1177 mailing list and a consensus about doing that has been
1178 reached.
1179 </p>
1180 </sect>
1182 <sect id="maintscripts">
1183 <heading>Maintainer Scripts</heading>
1186 The package installation scripts should avoid producing
1187 output which is unnecessary for the user to see and
1188 should rely on <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to stave off boredom on
1189 the part of a user installing many packages. This means,
1190 amongst other things, using the <tt>--quiet</tt> option on
1191 <prgn>install-info</prgn>.
1192 </p>
1195 Errors which occur during the execution of an installation
1196 script must be checked and the installation must not
1197 continue after an error.
1198 </p>
1201 Note that in general <ref id="scripts"> applies to package
1202 maintainer scripts, too.
1203 </p>
1206 You should not use <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> on a file
1207 belonging to another package without consulting the
1208 maintainer of that package first.
1209 </p>
1212 All packages which supply an instance of a common command
1213 name (or, in general, filename) should generally use
1214 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>, so that they may be
1215 installed together. If <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>
1216 is not used, then each package must use
1217 <tt>Conflicts</tt> to ensure that other packages are
1218 de-installed. (In this case, it may be appropriate to
1219 specify a conflict against earlier versions of something
1220 that previously did not use
1221 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>; this is an exception to
1222 the usual rule that versioned conflicts should be
1223 avoided.)
1224 </p>
1226 <sect1 id="maintscriptprompt">
1227 <heading>Prompting in maintainer scripts</heading>
1229 Package maintainer scripts may prompt the user if
1230 necessary. Prompting must be done by communicating
1231 through a program, such as <prgn>debconf</prgn>, which
1232 conforms to the Debian Configuration Management
1233 Specification, version 2 or higher.
1234 </p>
1237 Packages which are essential, or which are dependencies of
1238 essential packages, may fall back on another prompting method
1239 if no such interface is available when they are executed.
1240 </p>
1243 The Debian Configuration Management Specification is included
1244 in the <file>debconf_specification</file> files in the
1245 <package>debian-policy</package> package.
1246 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
1247 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/debconf_specification.html"
1248 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/debconf_specification.html"></tt>.
1249 </p>
1252 Packages which use the Debian Configuration Management
1253 Specification may contain an additional
1254 <prgn>config</prgn> script and a <tt>templates</tt>
1255 file in their control archive<footnote>
1256 The control.tar.gz inside the .deb.
1257 See <manref name="deb" section="5">.
1258 </footnote>.
1259 The <prgn>config</prgn> script might be run before the
1260 <prgn>preinst</prgn> script, and before the package is unpacked
1261 or any of its dependencies or pre-dependencies are satisfied.
1262 Therefore it must work using only the tools present in
1263 <em>essential</em> packages.<footnote>
1264 <package>Debconf</package> or another tool that
1265 implements the Debian Configuration Management
1266 Specification will also be installed, and any
1267 versioned dependencies on it will be satisfied
1268 before preconfiguration begins.
1269 </footnote>
1270 </p>
1273 Packages which use the Debian Configuration Management
1274 Specification must allow for translation of their user-visible
1275 messages by using a gettext-based system such as the one
1276 provided by the <package>po-debconf</package> package.
1277 </p>
1280 Packages should try to minimize the amount of prompting
1281 they need to do, and they should ensure that the user
1282 will only ever be asked each question once. This means
1283 that packages should try to use appropriate shared
1284 configuration files (such as <file>/etc/papersize</file> and
1285 <file>/etc/news/server</file>), and shared
1286 <package>debconf</package> variables rather than each
1287 prompting for their own list of required pieces of
1288 information.
1289 </p>
1292 It also means that an upgrade should not ask the same
1293 questions again, unless the user has used
1294 <tt>dpkg --purge</tt> to remove the package's configuration.
1295 The answers to configuration questions should be stored in an
1296 appropriate place in <file>/etc</file> so that the user can
1297 modify them, and how this has been done should be
1298 documented.
1299 </p>
1302 If a package has a vitally important piece of
1303 information to pass to the user (such as "don't run me
1304 as I am, you must edit the following configuration files
1305 first or you risk your system emitting badly-formatted
1306 messages"), it should display this in the
1307 <prgn>config</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn> script and
1308 prompt the user to hit return to acknowledge the
1309 message. Copyright messages do not count as vitally
1310 important (they belong in
1311 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>);
1312 neither do instructions on how to use a program (these
1313 should be in on-line documentation, where all the users
1314 can see them).
1315 </p>
1318 Any necessary prompting should almost always be confined
1319 to the <prgn>config</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn>
1320 script. If it is done in the <prgn>postinst</prgn>, it
1321 should be protected with a conditional so that
1322 unnecessary prompting doesn't happen if a package's
1323 installation fails and the <prgn>postinst</prgn> is
1324 called with <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>,
1325 <tt>abort-remove</tt> or <tt>abort-deconfigure</tt>.
1326 </p>
1327 </sect1>
1329 </sect>
1331 </chapt>
1334 <chapt id="source">
1335 <heading>Source packages</heading>
1337 <sect id="standardsversion">
1338 <heading>Standards conformance</heading>
1341 Source packages should specify the most recent version number
1342 of this policy document with which your package complied
1343 when it was last updated.
1344 </p>
1347 This information may be used to file bug reports
1348 automatically if your package becomes too much out of date.
1349 </p>
1352 The version is specified in the <tt>Standards-Version</tt>
1353 control field.
1354 The format of the <tt>Standards-Version</tt> field is
1355 described in <ref id="f-Standards-Version">.
1356 </p>
1359 You should regularly, and especially if your package has
1360 become out of date, check for the newest Policy Manual
1361 available and update your package, if necessary. When your
1362 package complies with the new standards you should update the
1363 <tt>Standards-Version</tt> source package field and
1364 release it.<footnote>
1365 See the file <file>upgrading-checklist</file> for
1366 information about policy which has changed between
1367 different versions of this document.
1368 </footnote>
1369 </p>
1371 </sect>
1373 <sect id="pkg-relations">
1374 <heading>Package relationships</heading>
1377 Source packages should specify which binary packages they
1378 require to be installed or not to be installed in order to
1379 build correctly. For example, if building a package
1380 requires a certain compiler, then the compiler should be
1381 specified as a build-time dependency.
1382 </p>
1385 It is not necessary to explicitly specify build-time
1386 relationships on a minimal set of packages that are always
1387 needed to compile, link and put in a Debian package a
1388 standard "Hello World!" program written in C or C++. The
1389 required packages are called <em>build-essential</em>, and
1390 an informational list can be found in
1391 <file>/usr/share/doc/build-essential/list</file> (which is
1392 contained in the <tt>build-essential</tt>
1393 package).<footnote>
1394 Rationale:
1395 <list compact="compact">
1396 <item>
1397 This allows maintaining the list separately
1398 from the policy documents (the list does not
1399 need the kind of control that the policy
1400 documents do).
1401 </item>
1402 <item>
1403 Having a separate package allows one to install
1404 the build-essential packages on a machine, as
1405 well as allowing other packages such as tasks to
1406 require installation of the build-essential
1407 packages using the depends relation.
1408 </item>
1409 <item>
1410 The separate package allows bug reports against
1411 the list to be categorized separately from
1412 the policy management process in the BTS.
1413 </item>
1414 </list>
1415 </footnote>
1416 </p>
1419 When specifying the set of build-time dependencies, one
1420 should list only those packages explicitly required by the
1421 build. It is not necessary to list packages which are
1422 required merely because some other package in the list of
1423 build-time dependencies depends on them.<footnote>
1424 The reason for this is that dependencies change, and
1425 you should list all those packages, and <em>only</em>
1426 those packages that <em>you</em> need directly. What
1427 others need is their business. For example, if you
1428 only link against <file>libimlib</file>, you will need to
1429 build-depend on <package>libimlib2-dev</package> but
1430 not against any <tt>libjpeg*</tt> packages, even
1431 though <tt>libimlib2-dev</tt> currently depends on
1432 them: installation of <package>libimlib2-dev</package>
1433 will automatically ensure that all of its run-time
1434 dependencies are satisfied.
1435 </footnote>
1436 </p>
1439 If build-time dependencies are specified, it must be
1440 possible to build the package and produce working binaries
1441 on a system with only essential and build-essential
1442 packages installed and also those required to satisfy the
1443 build-time relationships (including any implied
1444 relationships). In particular, this means that version
1445 clauses should be used rigorously in build-time
1446 relationships so that one cannot produce bad or
1447 inconsistently configured packages when the relationships
1448 are properly satisfied.
1449 </p>
1452 <ref id="relationships"> explains the technical details.
1453 </p>
1454 </sect>
1456 <sect>
1457 <heading>Changes to the upstream sources</heading>
1460 If changes to the source code are made that are not
1461 specific to the needs of the Debian system, they should be
1462 sent to the upstream authors in whatever form they prefer
1463 so as to be included in the upstream version of the
1464 package.
1465 </p>
1468 If you need to configure the package differently for
1469 Debian or for Linux, and the upstream source doesn't
1470 provide a way to do so, you should add such configuration
1471 facilities (for example, a new <prgn>autoconf</prgn> test
1472 or <tt>#define</tt>) and send the patch to the upstream
1473 authors, with the default set to the way they originally
1474 had it. You can then easily override the default in your
1475 <file>debian/rules</file> or wherever is appropriate.
1476 </p>
1479 You should make sure that the <prgn>configure</prgn> utility
1480 detects the correct architecture specification string
1481 (refer to <ref id="arch-spec"> for details).
1482 </p>
1485 If you need to edit a <prgn>Makefile</prgn> where GNU-style
1486 <prgn>configure</prgn> scripts are used, you should edit the
1487 <file>.in</file> files rather than editing the
1488 <prgn>Makefile</prgn> directly. This allows the user to
1489 reconfigure the package if necessary. You should
1490 <em>not</em> configure the package and edit the generated
1491 <prgn>Makefile</prgn>! This makes it impossible for someone
1492 else to later reconfigure the package without losing the
1493 changes you made.
1494 </p>
1496 </sect>
1498 <sect id="dpkgchangelog">
1499 <heading>Debian changelog: <file>debian/changelog</file></heading>
1502 Changes in the Debian version of the package should be
1503 briefly explained in the Debian changelog file
1504 <file>debian/changelog</file>.<footnote>
1506 Mistakes in changelogs are usually best rectified by
1507 making a new changelog entry rather than "rewriting
1508 history" by editing old changelog entries.
1509 </p>
1510 </footnote>
1511 This includes modifications
1512 made in the Debian package compared to the upstream one
1513 as well as other changes and updates to the package.
1514 <footnote>
1515 Although there is nothing stopping an author who is also
1516 the Debian maintainer from using this changelog for all
1517 their changes, it will have to be renamed if the Debian
1518 and upstream maintainers become different people. In such
1519 a case, however, it might be better to maintain the package
1520 as a non-native package.
1521 </footnote>
1522 </p>
1525 The format of the <file>debian/changelog</file> allows the
1526 package building tools to discover which version of the package
1527 is being built and find out other release-specific information.
1528 </p>
1531 That format is a series of entries like this:
1533 <example compact="compact">
1534 <var>package</var> (<var>version</var>) <var>distribution(s)</var>; urgency=<var>urgency</var>
1535 <var>
1536 [optional blank line(s), stripped]
1537 </var>
1538 * <var>change details</var>
1539 <var>more change details</var>
1540 <var>
1541 [blank line(s), included in output of dpkg-parsechangelog]
1542 </var>
1543 * <var>even more change details</var>
1544 <var>
1545 [optional blank line(s), stripped]
1546 </var>
1547 -- <var>maintainer name</var> &lt;<var>email address</var>&gt;<var>[two spaces]</var> <var>date</var>
1548 </example>
1549 </p>
1552 <var>package</var> and <var>version</var> are the source
1553 package name and version number.
1554 </p>
1557 <var>distribution(s)</var> lists the distributions where
1558 this version should be installed when it is uploaded - it
1559 is copied to the <tt>Distribution</tt> field in the
1560 <file>.changes</file> file. See <ref id="f-Distribution">.
1561 </p>
1564 <var>urgency</var> is the value for the <tt>Urgency</tt>
1565 field in the <file>.changes</file> file for the upload
1566 (see <ref id="f-Urgency">). It is not possible to specify
1567 an urgency containing commas; commas are used to separate
1568 <tt><var>keyword</var>=<var>value</var></tt> settings in the
1569 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> changelog format (though there is
1570 currently only one useful <var>keyword</var>,
1571 <tt>urgency</tt>).
1572 </p>
1575 The change details may in fact be any series of lines
1576 starting with at least two spaces, but conventionally each
1577 change starts with an asterisk and a separating space and
1578 continuation lines are indented so as to bring them in
1579 line with the start of the text above. Blank lines may be
1580 used here to separate groups of changes, if desired.
1581 </p>
1584 If this upload resolves bugs recorded in the Bug Tracking
1585 System (BTS), they may be automatically closed on the
1586 inclusion of this package into the Debian archive by
1587 including the string: <tt>closes: Bug#<var>nnnnn</var></tt>
1588 in the change details.<footnote>
1589 To be precise, the string should match the following
1590 Perl regular expression:
1591 <example>
1592 /closes:\s*(?:bug)?\#?\s?\d+(?:,\s*(?:bug)?\#?\s?\d+)*/i
1593 </example>
1594 Then all of the bug numbers listed will be closed by the
1595 archive maintenance script (<prgn>katie</prgn>) using the
1596 <var>version</var> of the changelog entry.
1597 </footnote>
1598 This information is conveyed via the <tt>Closes</tt> field
1599 in the <tt>.changes</tt> file (see <ref id="f-Closes">).
1600 </p>
1603 The maintainer name and email address used in the changelog
1604 should be the details of the person uploading <em>this</em>
1605 version. They are <em>not</em> necessarily those of the
1606 usual package maintainer. The information here will be
1607 copied to the <tt>Changed-By</tt> field in the
1608 <tt>.changes</tt> file (see <ref id="f-Changed-By">),
1609 and then later used to send an acknowledgement when the
1610 upload has been installed.
1611 </p>
1614 The <var>date</var> must be in RFC822 format<footnote>
1615 This is generated by <tt>date -R</tt>.
1616 </footnote>; it must include the time zone specified
1617 numerically, with the time zone name or abbreviation
1618 optionally present as a comment in parentheses.
1619 </p>
1622 The first "title" line with the package name must start
1623 at the left hand margin. The "trailer" line with the
1624 maintainer and date details must be preceded by exactly
1625 one space. The maintainer details and the date must be
1626 separated by exactly two spaces.
1627 </p>
1630 The entire changelog must be encoded in UTF-8.
1631 </p>
1634 For more information on placement of the changelog files
1635 within binary packages, please see <ref id="changelogs">.
1636 </p>
1637 </sect>
1639 <sect id="dpkgcopyright">
1640 <heading>Copyright: <file>debian/copyright</file></heading>
1642 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of
1643 its copyright and distribution license in the file
1644 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>
1645 (see <ref id="copyrightfile"> for further details). Also see
1646 <ref id="pkgcopyright"> for further considerations relayed
1647 to copyrights for packages.
1648 </p>
1649 </sect>
1650 <sect>
1651 <heading>Error trapping in makefiles</heading>
1654 When <prgn>make</prgn> invokes a command in a makefile
1655 (including your package's upstream makefiles and
1656 <file>debian/rules</file>), it does so using <prgn>sh</prgn>. This
1657 means that <prgn>sh</prgn>'s usual bad error handling
1658 properties apply: if you include a miniature script as one
1659 of the commands in your makefile you'll find that if you
1660 don't do anything about it then errors are not detected
1661 and <prgn>make</prgn> will blithely continue after
1662 problems.
1663 </p>
1666 Every time you put more than one shell command (this
1667 includes using a loop) in a makefile command you
1668 must make sure that errors are trapped. For
1669 simple compound commands, such as changing directory and
1670 then running a program, using <tt>&amp;&amp;</tt> rather
1671 than semicolon as a command separator is sufficient. For
1672 more complex commands including most loops and
1673 conditionals you should include a separate <tt>set -e</tt>
1674 command at the start of every makefile command that's
1675 actually one of these miniature shell scripts.
1676 </p>
1677 </sect>
1679 <sect id="timestamps">
1680 <heading>Time Stamps</heading>
1682 Maintainers should preserve the modification times of the
1683 upstream source files in a package, as far as is reasonably
1684 possible.<footnote>
1685 The rationale is that there is some information conveyed
1686 by knowing the age of the file, for example, you could
1687 recognize that some documentation is very old by looking
1688 at the modification time, so it would be nice if the
1689 modification time of the upstream source would be
1690 preserved.
1691 </footnote>
1692 </p>
1693 </sect>
1695 <sect id="restrictions">
1696 <heading>Restrictions on objects in source packages</heading>
1699 The source package may not contain any hard links<footnote>
1701 This is not currently detected when building source
1702 packages, but only when extracting
1703 them.
1704 </p>
1706 Hard links may be permitted at some point in the
1707 future, but would require a fair amount of
1708 work.
1709 </p>
1710 </footnote>, device special files, sockets or setuid or
1711 setgid files.<footnote>
1712 Setgid directories are allowed.
1713 </footnote>
1714 </p>
1715 </sect>
1717 <sect id="debianrules">
1718 <heading>Main building script: <file>debian/rules</file></heading>
1721 This file must be an executable makefile, and contains the
1722 package-specific recipes for compiling the package and
1723 building binary package(s) from the source.
1724 </p>
1727 It must start with the line <tt>#!/usr/bin/make -f</tt>,
1728 so that it can be invoked by saying its name rather than
1729 invoking <prgn>make</prgn> explicitly.
1730 </p>
1733 Since an interactive <file>debian/rules</file> script makes it
1734 impossible to auto-compile that package and also makes it
1735 hard for other people to reproduce the same binary
1736 package, all <em>required targets</em> MUST be
1737 non-interactive. At a minimum, required targets are the
1738 ones called by <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>, namely,
1739 <em>clean</em>, <em>binary</em>, <em>binary-arch</em>,
1740 <em>binary-indep</em>, and <em>build</em>. It also follows
1741 that any target that these targets depend on must also be
1742 non-interactive.
1743 </p>
1746 The targets are as follows (required unless stated otherwise):
1747 <taglist>
1748 <tag><tt>build</tt></tag>
1749 <item>
1751 The <tt>build</tt> target should perform all the
1752 configuration and compilation of the package.
1753 If a package has an interactive pre-build
1754 configuration routine, the Debianized source package
1755 must either be built after this has taken place (so
1756 that the binary package can be built without rerunning
1757 the configuration) or the configuration routine
1758 modified to become non-interactive. (The latter is
1759 preferable if there are architecture-specific features
1760 detected by the configuration routine.)
1761 </p>
1764 For some packages, notably ones where the same
1765 source tree is compiled in different ways to produce
1766 two binary packages, the <tt>build</tt> target
1767 does not make much sense. For these packages it is
1768 good enough to provide two (or more) targets
1769 (<tt>build-a</tt> and <tt>build-b</tt> or whatever)
1770 for each of the ways of building the package, and a
1771 <tt>build</tt> target that does nothing. The
1772 <tt>binary</tt> target will have to build the
1773 package in each of the possible ways and make the
1774 binary package out of each.
1775 </p>
1778 The <tt>build</tt> target must not do anything
1779 that might require root privilege.
1780 </p>
1783 The <tt>build</tt> target may need to run the
1784 <tt>clean</tt> target first - see below.
1785 </p>
1788 When a package has a configuration and build routine
1789 which takes a long time, or when the makefiles are
1790 poorly designed, or when <tt>build</tt> needs to
1791 run <tt>clean</tt> first, it is a good idea to
1792 <tt>touch build</tt> when the build process is
1793 complete. This will ensure that if <tt>debian/rules
1794 build</tt> is run again it will not rebuild the whole
1795 program.<footnote>
1796 Another common way to do this is for <tt>build</tt>
1797 to depend on <prgn>build-stamp</prgn> and to do
1798 nothing else, and for the <prgn>build-stamp</prgn>
1799 target to do the building and to <tt>touch
1800 build-stamp</tt> on completion. This is
1801 especially useful if the build routine creates a
1802 file or directory called <tt>build</tt>; in such a
1803 case, <tt>build</tt> will need to be listed as
1804 a phony target (i.e., as a dependency of the
1805 <tt>.PHONY</tt> target). See the documentation of
1806 <prgn>make</prgn> for more information on phony
1807 targets.
1808 </footnote>
1809 </p>
1810 </item>
1812 <tag><tt>build-arch</tt> (optional),
1813 <tt>build-indep</tt> (optional)
1814 </tag>
1815 <item>
1817 A package may also provide both of the targets
1818 <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt>.
1819 The <tt>build-arch</tt> target, if provided, should
1820 perform all the configuration and compilation required
1821 for producing all architecture-dependant binary packages
1822 (those packages for which the body of the
1823 <tt>Architecture</tt> field in <tt>debian/control</tt>
1824 is not <tt>all</tt>).
1825 Similarly, the <tt>build-indep</tt> target, if
1826 provided, should perform all the configuration and
1827 compilation required for producing all
1828 architecture-independent binary packages
1829 (those packages for which the body of the
1830 <tt>Architecture</tt> field in <tt>debian/control</tt>
1831 is <tt>all</tt>).
1832 The <tt>build</tt> target should depend on those of the
1833 targets <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt> that
1834 are provided in the rules file.
1835 </p>
1838 If one or both of the targets <tt>build-arch</tt> and
1839 <tt>build-indep</tt> are not provided, then invoking
1840 <file>debian/rules</file> with one of the not-provided
1841 targets as arguments should produce a exit status code
1842 of 2. Usually this is provided automatically by make
1843 if the target is missing.
1844 </p>
1847 The <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt> targets
1848 must not do anything that might require root privilege.
1849 </p>
1850 </item>
1852 <tag><tt>binary</tt>, <tt>binary-arch</tt>,
1853 <tt>binary-indep</tt>
1854 </tag>
1855 <item>
1857 The <tt>binary</tt> target must be all that is
1858 necessary for the user to build the binary package(s)
1859 produced from this source package. It is
1860 split into two parts: <prgn>binary-arch</prgn> builds
1861 the binary packages which are specific to a particular
1862 architecture, and <tt>binary-indep</tt> builds
1863 those which are not.
1864 </p>
1866 <tt>binary</tt> may be (and commonly is) a target with
1867 no commands which simply depends on
1868 <tt>binary-arch</tt> and <tt>binary-indep</tt>.
1869 </p>
1871 Both <tt>binary-*</tt> targets should depend on the
1872 <tt>build</tt> target, or on the appropriate
1873 <tt>build-arch</tt> or <tt>build-indep</tt> target, if
1874 provided, so that the package is built if it has not
1875 been already. It should then create the relevant
1876 binary package(s), using <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
1877 make their control files and <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> to
1878 build them and place them in the parent of the top
1879 level directory.
1880 </p>
1883 Both the <tt>binary-arch</tt> and
1884 <tt>binary-indep</tt> targets <em>must</em> exist.
1885 If one of them has nothing to do (which will always be
1886 the case if the source generates only a single binary
1887 package, whether architecture-dependent or not), it
1888 must still exist and must always succeed.
1889 </p>
1892 The <tt>binary</tt> targets must be invoked as
1893 root.<footnote>
1894 The <prgn>fakeroot</prgn> package often allows one
1895 to build a package correctly even without being
1896 root.
1897 </footnote>
1898 </p>
1899 </item>
1901 <tag><tt>clean</tt></tag>
1902 <item>
1904 This must undo any effects that the <tt>build</tt>
1905 and <tt>binary</tt> targets may have had, except
1906 that it should leave alone any output files created in
1907 the parent directory by a run of a <tt>binary</tt>
1908 target.
1909 </p>
1912 If a <tt>build</tt> file is touched at the end of
1913 the <tt>build</tt> target, as suggested above, it
1914 should be removed as the first action that
1915 <tt>clean</tt> performs, so that running
1916 <tt>build</tt> again after an interrupted
1917 <tt>clean</tt> doesn't think that everything is
1918 already done.
1919 </p>
1922 The <tt>clean</tt> target may need to be
1923 invoked as root if <tt>binary</tt> has been
1924 invoked since the last <tt>clean</tt>, or if
1925 <tt>build</tt> has been invoked as root (since
1926 <tt>build</tt> may create directories, for
1927 example).
1928 </p>
1929 </item>
1931 <tag><tt>get-orig-source</tt> (optional)</tag>
1932 <item>
1934 This target fetches the most recent version of the
1935 original source package from a canonical archive site
1936 (via FTP or WWW, for example), does any necessary
1937 rearrangement to turn it into the original source
1938 tar file format described below, and leaves it in the
1939 current directory.
1940 </p>
1943 This target may be invoked in any directory, and
1944 should take care to clean up any temporary files it
1945 may have left.
1946 </p>
1949 This target is optional, but providing it if
1950 possible is a good idea.
1951 </p>
1952 </item>
1954 <tag><tt>patch</tt> (optional)</tag>
1955 <item>
1957 This target performs whatever additional actions are
1958 required to make the source ready for editing (unpacking
1959 additional upstream archives, applying patches, etc.).
1960 It is recommended to be implemented for any package where
1961 <tt>dpkg-source -x</tt> does not result in source ready
1962 for additional modification. See
1963 <ref id="readmesource">.
1964 </p>
1965 </item>
1966 </taglist>
1969 The <tt>build</tt>, <tt>binary</tt> and
1970 <tt>clean</tt> targets must be invoked with the current
1971 directory being the package's top-level directory.
1972 </p>
1976 Additional targets may exist in <file>debian/rules</file>,
1977 either as published or undocumented interfaces or for the
1978 package's internal use.
1979 </p>
1982 The architectures we build on and build for are determined
1983 by <prgn>make</prgn> variables using the utility
1984 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-architecture"><prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn></qref>.
1985 You can determine the
1986 Debian architecture and the GNU style architecture
1987 specification string for the build machine (the machine type
1988 we are building on) as well as for the host machine (the
1989 machine type we are building for). Here is a list of
1990 supported <prgn>make</prgn> variables:
1991 <list compact="compact">
1992 <item>
1993 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH</tt> (the Debian architecture)
1994 </item>
1995 <item>
1996 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_CPU</tt> (the Debian CPU name)
1997 </item>
1998 <item>
1999 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_OS</tt> (the Debian System name)
2000 </item>
2001 <item>
2002 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt> (the GNU style architecture
2003 specification string)
2004 </item>
2005 <item>
2006 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_CPU</tt> (the CPU part of
2007 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt>)
2008 </item>
2009 <item>
2010 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_SYSTEM</tt> (the System part of
2011 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt>)
2012 </list>
2013 where <tt>*</tt> is either <tt>BUILD</tt> for specification of
2014 the build machine or <tt>HOST</tt> for specification of the
2015 host machine.
2016 </p>
2019 Backward compatibility can be provided in the rules file
2020 by setting the needed variables to suitable default
2021 values; please refer to the documentation of
2022 <prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn> for details.
2023 </p>
2026 It is important to understand that the <tt>DEB_*_ARCH</tt>
2027 string only determines which Debian architecture we are
2028 building on or for. It should not be used to get the CPU
2029 or system information; the <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_CPU</tt> and
2030 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_OS</tt> variables should be used for that.
2031 GNU style variables should generally only be used with upstream
2032 build systems.
2033 </p>
2035 <sect1 id="debianrules-options">
2036 <heading><file>debian/rules</file> and
2037 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt></heading>
2040 Supporting the standardized environment variable
2041 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt> is recommended. This variable can
2042 contain several flags to change how a package is compiled and
2043 built. Each flag must be in the form <var>flag</var> or
2044 <var>flag</var>=<var>options</var>. If multiple flags are
2045 given, they must be separated by whitespace.<footnote>
2046 Some packages support any delimiter, but whitespace is the
2047 easiest to parse inside a makefile and avoids ambiguity with
2048 flag values that contain commas.
2049 </footnote>
2050 <var>flag</var> must start with a lowercase letter
2051 (<tt>a-z</tt>) and consist only of lowercase letters,
2052 numbers (<tt>0-9</tt>), and the characters
2053 <tt>-</tt> and <tt>_</tt> (hyphen and underscore).
2054 <var>options</var> must not contain whitespace. The same
2055 tag should not be given multiple times with conflicting
2056 values. Package maintainers may assume that
2057 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt> will not contain conflicting tags.
2058 </p>
2061 The meaning of the following tags has been standardized:
2062 <taglist>
2063 <tag>nocheck</tag>
2064 <item>
2065 This tag says to not run any build-time test suite
2066 provided by the package.
2067 </item>
2068 <tag>noopt</tag>
2069 <item>
2070 The presence of this tag means that the package should
2071 be compiled with a minimum of optimization. For C
2072 programs, it is best to add <tt>-O0</tt> to
2073 <tt>CFLAGS</tt> (although this is usually the default).
2074 Some programs might fail to build or run at this level
2075 of optimization; it may be necessary to use
2076 <tt>-O1</tt>, for example.
2077 </item>
2078 <tag>nostrip</tag>
2079 <item>
2080 This tag means that the debugging symbols should not be
2081 stripped from the binary during installation, so that
2082 debugging information may be included in the package.
2083 </item>
2084 <tag>parallel=n</tag>
2085 <item>
2086 This tag means that the package should be built using up
2087 to <tt>n</tt> parallel processes if the package build
2088 system supports this.<footnote>
2089 Packages built with <tt>make</tt> can often implement
2090 this by passing the <tt>-j</tt><var>n</var> option to
2091 <tt>make</tt>.
2092 </footnote>
2093 If the package build system does not support parallel
2094 builds, this string must be ignored. If the package
2095 build system only supports a lower level of concurrency
2096 than <var>n</var>, the package should be built using as
2097 many parallel processes as the package build system
2098 supports. It is up to the package maintainer to decide
2099 whether the package build times are long enough and the
2100 package build system is robust enough to make supporting
2101 parallel builds worthwhile.
2102 </item>
2103 </taglist>
2104 </p>
2107 Unknown flags must be ignored by <file>debian/rules</file>.
2108 </p>
2111 The following makefile snippet is an example of how one may
2112 implement the build options; you will probably have to
2113 massage this example in order to make it work for your
2114 package.
2115 <example compact="compact">
2116 CFLAGS = -Wall -g
2117 INSTALL = install
2118 INSTALL_FILE = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 644
2119 INSTALL_PROGRAM = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 755
2120 INSTALL_SCRIPT = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 755
2121 INSTALL_DIR = $(INSTALL) -p -d -o root -g root -m 755
2123 ifneq (,$(filter noopt,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2124 CFLAGS += -O0
2125 else
2126 CFLAGS += -O2
2127 endif
2128 ifeq (,$(filter nostrip,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2129 INSTALL_PROGRAM += -s
2130 endif
2131 ifneq (,$(filter parallel=%,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2132 NUMJOBS = $(patsubst parallel=%,%,$(filter parallel=%,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2133 MAKEFLAGS += -j$(NUMJOBS)
2134 endif
2136 build:
2137 # ...
2138 ifeq (,$(filter nocheck,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2139 # Code to run the package test suite.
2140 endif
2141 </example>
2142 </p>
2143 </sect1>
2144 </sect>
2146 <!-- FIXME: section pkg-srcsubstvars is the same as substvars -->
2147 <sect id="substvars">
2148 <heading>Variable substitutions: <file>debian/substvars</file></heading>
2151 When <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>,
2152 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> and <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
2153 generate control files they perform variable substitutions
2154 on their output just before writing it. Variable
2155 substitutions have the form <tt>${<var>variable</var>}</tt>.
2156 The optional file <file>debian/substvars</file> contains
2157 variable substitutions to be used; variables can also be set
2158 directly from <file>debian/rules</file> using the <tt>-V</tt>
2159 option to the source packaging commands, and certain
2160 predefined variables are also available.
2161 </p>
2164 The <file>debian/substvars</file> file is usually generated and
2165 modified dynamically by <file>debian/rules</file> targets, in
2166 which case it must be removed by the <tt>clean</tt> target.
2167 </p>
2170 See <manref name="deb-substvars" section="5"> for full
2171 details about source variable substitutions, including the
2172 format of <file>debian/substvars</file>.</p>
2173 </sect>
2175 <sect id="debianwatch">
2176 <heading>Optional upstream source location: <file>debian/watch</file></heading>
2179 This is an optional, recommended control file for the
2180 <tt>uscan</tt> utility which defines how to automatically
2181 scan ftp or http sites for newly available updates of the
2182 package. This is used by <url id="
2183 http://dehs.alioth.debian.org/"> and other Debian QA tools
2184 to help with quality control and maintenance of the
2185 distribution as a whole.
2186 </p>
2188 </sect>
2190 <sect id="debianfiles">
2191 <heading>Generated files list: <file>debian/files</file></heading>
2194 This file is not a permanent part of the source tree; it
2195 is used while building packages to record which files are
2196 being generated. <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> uses it
2197 when it generates a <file>.changes</file> file.
2198 </p>
2201 It should not exist in a shipped source package, and so it
2202 (and any backup files or temporary files such as
2203 <file>files.new</file><footnote>
2204 <file>files.new</file> is used as a temporary file by
2205 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> and
2206 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> - they write a new
2207 version of <tt>files</tt> here before renaming it,
2208 to avoid leaving a corrupted copy if an error
2209 occurs.
2210 </footnote>) should be removed by the
2211 <tt>clean</tt> target. It may also be wise to
2212 ensure a fresh start by emptying or removing it at the
2213 start of the <tt>binary</tt> target.
2214 </p>
2217 When <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> is run for a binary
2218 package, it adds an entry to <file>debian/files</file> for the
2219 <file>.deb</file> file that will be created when <tt>dpkg-deb
2220 --build</tt> is run for that binary package. So for most
2221 packages all that needs to be done with this file is to
2222 delete it in the <tt>clean</tt> target.
2223 </p>
2226 If a package upload includes files besides the source
2227 package and any binary packages whose control files were
2228 made with <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> then they should be
2229 placed in the parent of the package's top-level directory
2230 and <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> should be called to add
2231 the file to the list in <file>debian/files</file>.</p>
2232 </sect>
2234 <sect id="embeddedfiles">
2235 <heading>Convenience copies of code</heading>
2238 Some software packages include in their distribution convenience
2239 copies of code from other software packages, generally so that
2240 users compiling from source don't have to download multiple
2241 packages. Debian packages should not make use of these
2242 convenience copies unless the included package is explicitly
2243 intended to be used in this way.<footnote>
2244 For example, parts of the GNU build system work like this.
2245 </footnote>
2246 If the included code is already in the Debian archive in the
2247 form of a library, the Debian packaging should ensure that
2248 binary packages reference the libraries already in Debian and
2249 the convenience copy is not used. If the included code is not
2250 already in Debian, it should be packaged separately as a
2251 prerequisite if possible.
2252 <footnote>
2253 Having multiple copies of the same code in Debian is
2254 inefficient, often creates either static linking or shared
2255 library conflicts, and, most importantly, increases the
2256 difficulty of handling security vulnerabilities in the
2257 duplicated code.
2258 </footnote>
2259 </p>
2260 </sect>
2262 <sect id="readmesource">
2263 <heading>Source package handling:
2264 <file>debian/README.source</file></heading>
2267 If running <prgn>dpkg-source -x</prgn> on a source package
2268 doesn't produce the source of the package, ready for editing,
2269 and allow one to make changes and run
2270 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> to produce a modified package
2271 without taking any additional steps, creating a
2272 <file>debian/README.source</file> documentation file is
2273 recommended. This file should explain how to do all of the
2274 following:
2275 <enumlist>
2276 <item>Generate the fully patched source, in a form ready for
2277 editing, that would be built to create Debian
2278 packages. Doing this with a <tt>patch</tt> target in
2279 <file>debian/rules</file> is recommended; see
2280 <ref id="debianrules">.</item>
2281 <item>Modify the source and save those modifications so that
2282 they will be applied when building the package.</item>
2283 <item>Remove source modifications that are currently being
2284 applied when building the package.</item>
2285 <item>Optionally, document what steps are necessary to
2286 upgrade the Debian source package to a new upstream version,
2287 if applicable.</item>
2288 </enumlist>
2289 This explanation should include specific commands and mention
2290 any additional required Debian packages. It should not assume
2291 familiarity with any specific Debian packaging system or patch
2292 management tools.
2293 </p>
2296 This explanation may refer to a documentation file installed by
2297 one of the package's build dependencies provided that the
2298 referenced documentation clearly explains these tasks and is not
2299 a general reference manual.
2300 </p>
2303 <file>debian/README.source</file> may also include any other
2304 information that would be helpful to someone modifying the
2305 source package. Even if the package doesn't fit the above
2306 description, maintainers are encouraged to document in a
2307 <file>debian/README.source</file> file any source package with a
2308 particularly complex or unintuitive source layout or build
2309 system (for example, a package that builds the same source
2310 multiple times to generate different binary packages).
2311 </p>
2312 </sect>
2313 </chapt>
2316 <chapt id="controlfields">
2317 <heading>Control files and their fields</heading>
2320 The package management system manipulates data represented in
2321 a common format, known as <em>control data</em>, stored in
2322 <em>control files</em>.
2323 Control files are used for source packages, binary packages and
2324 the <file>.changes</file> files which control the installation
2325 of uploaded files<footnote>
2326 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s internal databases are in a similar
2327 format.
2328 </footnote>.
2329 </p>
2331 <sect id="controlsyntax">
2332 <heading>Syntax of control files</heading>
2335 A control file consists of one or more paragraphs of
2336 fields<footnote>
2337 The paragraphs are also sometimes referred to as stanzas.
2338 </footnote>.
2339 The paragraphs are separated by blank lines. Some control
2340 files allow only one paragraph; others allow several, in
2341 which case each paragraph usually refers to a different
2342 package. (For example, in source packages, the first
2343 paragraph refers to the source package, and later paragraphs
2344 refer to binary packages generated from the source.)
2345 </p>
2348 Each paragraph consists of a series of data fields; each
2349 field consists of the field name, followed by a colon and
2350 then the data/value associated with that field. It ends at
2351 the end of the (logical) line. Horizontal whitespace
2352 (spaces and tabs) may occur immediately before or after the
2353 value and is ignored there; it is conventional to put a
2354 single space after the colon. For example, a field might
2356 <example compact="compact">
2357 Package: libc6
2358 </example>
2359 the field name is <tt>Package</tt> and the field value
2360 <tt>libc6</tt>.
2361 </p>
2364 Many fields' values may span several lines; in this case
2365 each continuation line must start with a space or a tab.
2366 Any trailing spaces or tabs at the end of individual
2367 lines of a field value are ignored.
2368 </p>
2371 In fields where it is specified that lines may not wrap,
2372 only a single line of data is allowed and whitespace is not
2373 significant in a field body. Whitespace must not appear
2374 inside names (of packages, architectures, files or anything
2375 else) or version numbers, or between the characters of
2376 multi-character version relationships.
2377 </p>
2380 Field names are not case-sensitive, but it is usual to
2381 capitalize the field names using mixed case as shown below.
2382 </p>
2385 Blank lines, or lines consisting only of spaces and tabs,
2386 are not allowed within field values or between fields - that
2387 would mean a new paragraph.
2388 </p>
2391 All control files must be encoded in UTF-8.
2392 </p>
2393 </sect>
2395 <sect id="sourcecontrolfiles">
2396 <heading>Source package control files -- <file>debian/control</file></heading>
2399 The <file>debian/control</file> file contains the most vital
2400 (and version-independent) information about the source package
2401 and about the binary packages it creates.
2402 </p>
2405 The first paragraph of the control file contains information about
2406 the source package in general. The subsequent sets each describe a
2407 binary package that the source tree builds.
2408 </p>
2411 The fields in the general paragraph (the first one, for the source
2412 package) are:
2414 <list compact="compact">
2415 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2416 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2417 <item><qref id="f-Uploaders"><tt>Uploaders</tt></qref></item>
2418 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2419 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2420 <item><qref id="sourcebinarydeps"><tt>Build-Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2421 <item><qref id="f-Standards-Version"><tt>Standards-Version</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2422 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2423 </list>
2424 </p>
2427 The fields in the binary package paragraphs are:
2429 <list compact="compact">
2430 <item><qref id="f-Package"><tt>Package</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2431 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2432 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2433 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2434 <item><qref id="f-Essential"><tt>Essential</tt></qref></item>
2435 <item><qref id="binarydeps"><tt>Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2436 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2437 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2438 </list>
2439 </p>
2442 The syntax and semantics of the fields are described below.
2443 </p>
2445 <!-- stuff -->
2448 These fields are used by <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
2449 generate control files for binary packages (see below), by
2450 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> to generate the
2451 <tt>.changes</tt> file to accompany the upload, and by
2452 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> when it creates the
2453 <file>.dsc</file> source control file as part of a source
2454 archive. Many fields are permitted to span multiple lines in
2455 <file>debian/control</file> but not in any other control
2456 file. These tools are responsible for removing the line
2457 breaks from such fields when using fields from
2458 <file>debian/control</file> to generate other control files.
2459 </p>
2462 The fields here may contain variable references - their
2463 values will be substituted by <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>,
2464 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> or <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
2465 when they generate output control files.
2466 See <ref id="substvars"> for details.
2467 </p>
2470 In addition to the control file syntax described <qref
2471 id="controlsyntax">above</qref>, this file may also contain
2472 comment lines starting with <tt>#</tt> without any preceding
2473 whitespace. All such lines are ignored, even in the middle of
2474 continuation lines for a multiline field, and do not end a
2475 multiline field.
2476 </p>
2478 </sect>
2480 <sect id="binarycontrolfiles">
2481 <heading>Binary package control files -- <file>DEBIAN/control</file></heading>
2484 The <file>DEBIAN/control</file> file contains the most vital
2485 (and version-dependent) information about a binary package.
2486 </p>
2489 The fields in this file are:
2491 <list compact="compact">
2492 <item><qref id="f-Package"><tt>Package</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2493 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref></item>
2494 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2495 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2496 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2497 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2498 <item><qref id="f-Essential"><tt>Essential</tt></qref></item>
2499 <item><qref id="binarydeps"><tt>Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2500 <item><qref id="f-Installed-Size"><tt>Installed-Size</tt></qref></item>
2501 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2502 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2503 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2504 </list>
2505 </p>
2506 </sect>
2508 <sect id="debiansourcecontrolfiles">
2509 <heading>Debian source control files -- <tt>.dsc</tt></heading>
2512 This file contains a series of fields, identified and
2513 separated just like the fields in the control file of
2514 a binary package. The fields are listed below; their
2515 syntax is described above, in <ref id="pkg-controlfields">.
2517 <list compact="compact">
2518 <item><qref id="f-Format"><tt>Format</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2519 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2520 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2521 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2522 <item><qref id="f-Uploaders"><tt>Uploaders</tt></qref></item>
2523 <item><qref id="f-Binary"><tt>Binary</tt></qref></item>
2524 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref></item>
2525 <item><qref id="sourcebinarydeps"><tt>Build-Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2526 <item><qref id="f-Standards-Version"><tt>Standards-Version</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2527 <item><qref id="f-Files"><tt>Files</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2528 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2529 </list>
2530 </p>
2533 The source package control file is generated by
2534 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> when it builds the source
2535 archive, from other files in the source package,
2536 described above. When unpacking, it is checked against
2537 the files and directories in the other parts of the
2538 source package.
2539 </p>
2541 </sect>
2543 <sect id="debianchangesfiles">
2544 <heading>Debian changes files -- <file>.changes</file></heading>
2547 The .changes files are used by the Debian archive maintenance
2548 software to process updates to packages. They contain one
2549 paragraph which contains information from the
2550 <tt>debian/control</tt> file and other data about the
2551 source package gathered via <tt>debian/changelog</tt>
2552 and <tt>debian/rules</tt>.
2553 </p>
2556 The fields in this file are:
2558 <list compact="compact">
2559 <item><qref id="f-Format"><tt>Format</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2560 <item><qref id="f-Date"><tt>Date</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2561 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2562 <item><qref id="f-Binary"><tt>Binary</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2563 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2564 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2565 <item><qref id="f-Distribution"><tt>Distribution</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2566 <item><qref id="f-Urgency"><tt>Urgency</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2567 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2568 <item><qref id="f-Changed-By"><tt>Changed-By</tt></qref></item>
2569 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2570 <item><qref id="f-Closes"><tt>Closes</tt></qref></item>
2571 <item><qref id="f-Changes"><tt>Changes</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2572 <item><qref id="f-Files"><tt>Files</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2573 </list>
2574 </p>
2575 </sect>
2577 <sect id="controlfieldslist">
2578 <heading>List of fields</heading>
2580 <sect1 id="f-Source">
2581 <heading><tt>Source</tt></heading>
2584 This field identifies the source package name.
2585 </p>
2588 In <file>debian/control</file> or a <file>.dsc</file> file,
2589 this field must contain only the name of the source package.
2590 </p>
2593 In a binary package control file or a <file>.changes</file>
2594 file, the source package name may be followed by a version
2595 number in parentheses<footnote>
2596 It is customary to leave a space after the package name
2597 if a version number is specified.
2598 </footnote>.
2599 This version number may be omitted (and is, by
2600 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>) if it has the same value as
2601 the <tt>Version</tt> field of the binary package in
2602 question. The field itself may be omitted from a binary
2603 package control file when the source package has the same
2604 name and version as the binary package.
2605 </p>
2608 Package names must consist only of lower case letters
2609 (<tt>a-z</tt>), digits (<tt>0-9</tt>), plus (<tt>+</tt>)
2610 and minus (<tt>-</tt>) signs, and periods (<tt>.</tt>).
2611 They must be at least two characters long and must start
2612 with an alphanumeric character.
2613 </p>
2614 </sect1>
2616 <sect1 id="f-Maintainer">
2617 <heading><tt>Maintainer</tt></heading>
2620 The package maintainer's name and email address. The name
2621 should come first, then the email address inside angle
2622 brackets <tt>&lt;&gt</tt> (in RFC822 format).
2623 </p>
2626 If the maintainer's name contains a full stop then the
2627 whole field will not work directly as an email address due
2628 to a misfeature in the syntax specified in RFC822; a
2629 program using this field as an address must check for this
2630 and correct the problem if necessary (for example by
2631 putting the name in round brackets and moving it to the
2632 end, and bringing the email address forward).
2633 </p>
2634 </sect1>
2636 <sect1 id="f-Uploaders">
2637 <heading><tt>Uploaders</tt></heading>
2640 List of the names and email addresses of co-maintainers of
2641 the package, if any. If the package has other maintainers
2642 beside the one named in the
2643 <qref id="f-Maintainer">Maintainer field</qref>, their
2644 names and email addresses should be listed here. The
2645 format is the same as that of the Maintainer tag, and
2646 multiple entries should be comma separated. Currently,
2647 this field is restricted to a single line of data. This
2648 is an optional field.
2649 </p>
2651 Any parser that interprets the Uploaders field in
2652 <file>debian/control</file> must permit it to span multiple
2653 lines. Line breaks in an Uploaders field that spans multiple
2654 lines are not significant and the semantics of the field are
2655 the same as if the line breaks had not been present.
2656 </p>
2657 </sect1>
2659 <sect1 id="f-Changed-By">
2660 <heading><tt>Changed-By</tt></heading>
2663 The name and email address of the person who changed the
2664 said package. Usually the name of the maintainer.
2665 All the rules for the Maintainer field apply here, too.
2666 </p>
2667 </sect1>
2669 <sect1 id="f-Section">
2670 <heading><tt>Section</tt></heading>
2673 This field specifies an application area into which the package
2674 has been classified. See <ref id="subsections">.
2675 </p>
2678 When it appears in the <file>debian/control</file> file,
2679 it gives the value for the subfield of the same name in
2680 the <tt>Files</tt> field of the <file>.changes</file> file.
2681 It also gives the default for the same field in the binary
2682 packages.
2683 </p>
2684 </sect1>
2686 <sect1 id="f-Priority">
2687 <heading><tt>Priority</tt></heading>
2690 This field represents how important that it is that the user
2691 have the package installed. See <ref id="priorities">.
2692 </p>
2695 When it appears in the <file>debian/control</file> file,
2696 it gives the value for the subfield of the same name in
2697 the <tt>Files</tt> field of the <file>.changes</file> file.
2698 It also gives the default for the same field in the binary
2699 packages.
2700 </p>
2701 </sect1>
2703 <sect1 id="f-Package">
2704 <heading><tt>Package</tt></heading>
2707 The name of the binary package.
2708 </p>
2711 Package names must consist only of lower case letters
2712 (<tt>a-z</tt>), digits (<tt>0-9</tt>), plus (<tt>+</tt>)
2713 and minus (<tt>-</tt>) signs, and periods (<tt>.</tt>).
2714 They must be at least two characters long and must start
2715 with an alphanumeric character.
2716 </p>
2717 </sect1>
2719 <sect1 id="f-Architecture">
2720 <heading><tt>Architecture</tt></heading>
2723 Depending on context and the control file used, the
2724 <tt>Architecture</tt> field can include the following sets of
2725 values:
2726 <list>
2727 <item>A unique single word identifying a Debian machine
2728 architecture as described in <ref id="arch-spec">.
2729 <item><tt>all</tt>, which indicates an
2730 architecture-independent package.
2731 <item><tt>any</tt>, which indicates a package available
2732 for building on any architecture.
2733 <item><tt>source</tt>, which indicates a source package.
2734 </list>
2735 </p>
2738 In the main <file>debian/control</file> file in the source
2739 package, this field may contain the special value
2740 <tt>any</tt>, the special value <tt>all</tt>, or a list of
2741 architectures separated by spaces. If <tt>any</tt> or
2742 <tt>all</tt> appear, they must be the entire contents of the
2743 field. Most packages will use either <tt>any</tt> or
2744 <tt>all</tt>. Specifying a specific list of architectures is
2745 for the minority of cases where a program is not portable or
2746 is not useful on some architectures, and where possible the
2747 program should be made portable instead.
2748 </p>
2751 In the source package control file <file>.dsc</file>, this
2752 field may contain either the special value <tt>any</tt> or a
2753 list of architectures separated by spaces. If a list is given,
2754 it may include (or consist solely of) the special value
2755 <tt>all</tt>. In other words, in <file>.dsc</file> files
2756 unlike the <file>debian/control</file>, <tt>all</tt> may occur
2757 in combination with specific architectures. The
2758 <tt>Architecture</tt> field in the source package control file
2759 <file>.dsc</file> is generally constructed from the
2760 <tt>Architecture</tt> fields in the
2761 <file>debian/control</file> in the source package.
2762 </p>
2765 Specifying <tt>any</tt> indicates that the source package
2766 isn't dependent on any particular architecture and should
2767 compile fine on any one. The produced binary package(s)
2768 will either be specific to whatever the current build
2769 architecture is or will be architecture-independent.
2770 </p>
2773 Specifying only <tt>all</tt> indicates that the source package
2774 will only build architecture-independent packages. If this is
2775 the case, <tt>all</tt> must be used rather than <tt>any</tt>;
2776 <tt>any</tt> implies that the source package will build at
2777 least one architecture-dependent package.
2778 </p>
2781 Specifying a list of architectures indicates that the source
2782 will build an architecture-dependent package, and will only
2783 work correctly on the listed architectures. If the source
2784 package also builds at least one architecture-independent
2785 package, <tt>all</tt> will also be included in the list.
2786 </p>
2789 In a <file>.changes</file> file, the <tt>Architecture</tt>
2790 field lists the architecture(s) of the package(s)
2791 currently being uploaded. This will be a list; if the
2792 source for the package is also being uploaded, the special
2793 entry <tt>source</tt> is also present. <tt>all</tt> will be
2794 present if any architecture-independent packages are being
2795 uploaded. <tt>any</tt> may never occur in the
2796 <tt>Architecture</tt> field in the <file>.changes</file>
2797 file.
2798 </p>
2801 See <ref id="debianrules"> for information how to get the
2802 architecture for the build process.
2803 </p>
2804 </sect1>
2806 <sect1 id="f-Essential">
2807 <heading><tt>Essential</tt></heading>
2810 This is a boolean field which may occur only in the
2811 control file of a binary package or in a per-package fields
2812 paragraph of a main source control data file.
2813 </p>
2816 If set to <tt>yes</tt> then the package management system
2817 will refuse to remove the package (upgrading and replacing
2818 it is still possible). The other possible value is <tt>no</tt>,
2819 which is the same as not having the field at all.
2820 </p>
2821 </sect1>
2823 <sect1>
2824 <heading>Package interrelationship fields:
2825 <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
2826 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>,
2827 <tt>Breaks</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt>,
2828 <tt>Provides</tt>, <tt>Replaces</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>
2829 </heading>
2832 These fields describe the package's relationships with
2833 other packages. Their syntax and semantics are described
2834 in <ref id="relationships">.</p>
2835 </sect1>
2837 <sect1 id="f-Standards-Version">
2838 <heading><tt>Standards-Version</tt></heading>
2841 The most recent version of the standards (the policy
2842 manual and associated texts) with which the package
2843 complies.
2844 </p>
2847 The version number has four components: major and minor
2848 version number and major and minor patch level. When the
2849 standards change in a way that requires every package to
2850 change the major number will be changed. Significant
2851 changes that will require work in many packages will be
2852 signaled by a change to the minor number. The major patch
2853 level will be changed for any change to the meaning of the
2854 standards, however small; the minor patch level will be
2855 changed when only cosmetic, typographical or other edits
2856 are made which neither change the meaning of the document
2857 nor affect the contents of packages.
2858 </p>
2861 Thus only the first three components of the policy version
2862 are significant in the <em>Standards-Version</em> control
2863 field, and so either these three components or the all
2864 four components may be specified.<footnote>
2865 In the past, people specified the full version number
2866 in the Standards-Version field, for example "2.3.0.0".
2867 Since minor patch-level changes don't introduce new
2868 policy, it was thought it would be better to relax
2869 policy and only require the first 3 components to be
2870 specified, in this example "2.3.0". All four
2871 components may still be used if someone wishes to do so.
2872 </footnote>
2873 </p>
2875 </sect1>
2877 <sect1 id="f-Version">
2878 <heading><tt>Version</tt></heading>
2881 The version number of a package. The format is:
2882 [<var>epoch</var><tt>:</tt>]<var>upstream_version</var>[<tt>-</tt><var>debian_revision</var>]
2883 </p>
2886 The three components here are:
2887 <taglist>
2888 <tag><var>epoch</var></tag>
2889 <item>
2891 This is a single (generally small) unsigned integer. It
2892 may be omitted, in which case zero is assumed. If it is
2893 omitted then the <var>upstream_version</var> may not
2894 contain any colons.
2895 </p>
2898 It is provided to allow mistakes in the version numbers
2899 of older versions of a package, and also a package's
2900 previous version numbering schemes, to be left behind.
2901 </p>
2902 </item>
2904 <tag><var>upstream_version</var></tag>
2905 <item>
2907 This is the main part of the version number. It is
2908 usually the version number of the original ("upstream")
2909 package from which the <file>.deb</file> file has been made,
2910 if this is applicable. Usually this will be in the same
2911 format as that specified by the upstream author(s);
2912 however, it may need to be reformatted to fit into the
2913 package management system's format and comparison
2914 scheme.
2915 </p>
2918 The comparison behavior of the package management system
2919 with respect to the <var>upstream_version</var> is
2920 described below. The <var>upstream_version</var>
2921 portion of the version number is mandatory.
2922 </p>
2925 The <var>upstream_version</var> may contain only
2926 alphanumerics<footnote>
2927 Alphanumerics are <tt>A-Za-z0-9</tt> only.
2928 </footnote>
2929 and the characters <tt>.</tt> <tt>+</tt> <tt>-</tt>
2930 <tt>:</tt> <tt>~</tt> (full stop, plus, hyphen, colon,
2931 tilde) and should start with a digit. If there is no
2932 <var>debian_revision</var> then hyphens are not allowed;
2933 if there is no <var>epoch</var> then colons are not
2934 allowed.
2935 </p>
2936 </item>
2938 <tag><var>debian_revision</var></tag>
2939 <item>
2941 This part of the version number specifies the version of
2942 the Debian package based on the upstream version. It
2943 may contain only alphanumerics and the characters
2944 <tt>+</tt> <tt>.</tt> <tt>~</tt> (plus, full stop,
2945 tilde) and is compared in the same way as the
2946 <var>upstream_version</var> is.
2947 </p>
2950 It is optional; if it isn't present then the
2951 <var>upstream_version</var> may not contain a hyphen.
2952 This format represents the case where a piece of
2953 software was written specifically to be turned into a
2954 Debian package, and so there is only one "debianisation"
2955 of it and therefore no revision indication is required.
2956 </p>
2959 It is conventional to restart the
2960 <var>debian_revision</var> at <tt>1</tt> each time the
2961 <var>upstream_version</var> is increased.
2962 </p>
2965 The package management system will break the version
2966 number apart at the last hyphen in the string (if there
2967 is one) to determine the <var>upstream_version</var> and
2968 <var>debian_revision</var>. The absence of a
2969 <var>debian_revision</var> is equivalent to a
2970 <var>debian_revision</var> of <tt>0</tt>.
2971 </p>
2972 </item>
2973 </taglist>
2974 </p>
2977 When comparing two version numbers, first the <var>epoch</var>
2978 of each are compared, then the <var>upstream_version</var> if
2979 <var>epoch</var> is equal, and then <var>debian_revision</var>
2980 if <var>upstream_version</var> is also equal.
2981 <var>epoch</var> is compared numerically. The
2982 <var>upstream_version</var> and <var>debian_revision</var>
2983 parts are compared by the package management system using the
2984 following algorithm:
2985 </p>
2988 The strings are compared from left to right.
2989 </p>
2992 First the initial part of each string consisting entirely of
2993 non-digit characters is determined. These two parts (one of
2994 which may be empty) are compared lexically. If a difference
2995 is found it is returned. The lexical comparison is a
2996 comparison of ASCII values modified so that all the letters
2997 sort earlier than all the non-letters and so that a tilde
2998 sorts before anything, even the end of a part. For example,
2999 the following parts are in sorted order from earliest to
3000 latest: <tt>~~</tt>, <tt>~~a</tt>, <tt>~</tt>, the empty part,
3001 <tt>a</tt>.<footnote>
3002 One common use of <tt>~</tt> is for upstream pre-releases.
3003 For example, <tt>1.0~beta1~svn1245</tt> sorts earlier than
3004 <tt>1.0~beta1</tt>, which sorts earlier than <tt>1.0</tt>.
3005 </footnote>
3006 </p>
3009 Then the initial part of the remainder of each string which
3010 consists entirely of digit characters is determined. The
3011 numerical values of these two parts are compared, and any
3012 difference found is returned as the result of the comparison.
3013 For these purposes an empty string (which can only occur at
3014 the end of one or both version strings being compared) counts
3015 as zero.
3016 </p>
3019 These two steps (comparing and removing initial non-digit
3020 strings and initial digit strings) are repeated until a
3021 difference is found or both strings are exhausted.
3022 </p>
3025 Note that the purpose of epochs is to allow us to leave behind
3026 mistakes in version numbering, and to cope with situations
3027 where the version numbering scheme changes. It is
3028 <em>not</em> intended to cope with version numbers containing
3029 strings of letters which the package management system cannot
3030 interpret (such as <tt>ALPHA</tt> or <tt>pre-</tt>), or with
3031 silly orderings (the author of this manual has heard of a
3032 package whose versions went <tt>1.1</tt>, <tt>1.2</tt>,
3033 <tt>1.3</tt>, <tt>1</tt>, <tt>2.1</tt>, <tt>2.2</tt>,
3034 <tt>2</tt> and so forth).
3035 </p>
3036 </sect1>
3038 <sect1 id="f-Description">
3039 <heading><tt>Description</tt></heading>
3042 In a source or binary control file, the <tt>Description</tt>
3043 field contains a description of the binary package, consisting
3044 of two parts, the synopsis or the short description, and the
3045 long description. The field's format is as follows:
3046 </p>
3049 <example>
3050 Description: &lt;single line synopsis&gt;
3051 &lt;extended description over several lines&gt;
3052 </example>
3053 </p>
3056 The lines in the extended description can have these formats:
3057 </p>
3059 <p><list>
3061 <item>
3062 Those starting with a single space are part of a paragraph.
3063 Successive lines of this form will be word-wrapped when
3064 displayed. The leading space will usually be stripped off.
3065 </item>
3067 <item>
3068 Those starting with two or more spaces. These will be
3069 displayed verbatim. If the display cannot be panned
3070 horizontally, the displaying program will line wrap them "hard"
3071 (i.e., without taking account of word breaks). If it can they
3072 will be allowed to trail off to the right. None, one or two
3073 initial spaces may be deleted, but the number of spaces
3074 deleted from each line will be the same (so that you can have
3075 indenting work correctly, for example).
3076 </item>
3078 <item>
3079 Those containing a single space followed by a single full stop
3080 character. These are rendered as blank lines. This is the
3081 <em>only</em> way to get a blank line<footnote>
3082 Completely empty lines will not be rendered as blank lines.
3083 Instead, they will cause the parser to think you're starting
3084 a whole new record in the control file, and will therefore
3085 likely abort with an error.
3086 </footnote>.
3087 </item>
3089 <item>
3090 Those containing a space, a full stop and some more characters.
3091 These are for future expansion. Do not use them.
3092 </item>
3094 </list></p>
3097 Do not use tab characters. Their effect is not predictable.
3098 </p>
3101 See <ref id="descriptions"> for further information on this.
3102 </p>
3105 In a <file>.changes</file> file, the <tt>Description</tt> field
3106 contains a summary of the descriptions for the packages being
3107 uploaded.
3108 </p>
3111 The part of the field before the first newline is empty;
3112 thereafter each line has the name of a binary package and
3113 the summary description line from that binary package.
3114 Each line is indented by one space.
3115 </p>
3117 </sect1>
3119 <sect1 id="f-Distribution">
3120 <heading><tt>Distribution</tt></heading>
3123 In a <file>.changes</file> file or parsed changelog output
3124 this contains the (space-separated) name(s) of the
3125 distribution(s) where this version of the package should
3126 be installed. Valid distributions are determined by the
3127 archive maintainers.<footnote>
3128 Example distribution names in the Debian archive used in
3129 <file>.changes</file> files are:
3130 <taglist compact="compact">
3131 <tag><em>unstable</em></tag>
3132 <item>
3133 This distribution value refers to the
3134 <em>developmental</em> part of the Debian distribution
3135 tree. Most new packages, new upstream versions of
3136 packages and bug fixes go into the <em>unstable</em>
3137 directory tree.
3138 </item>
3140 <tag><em>experimental</em></tag>
3141 <item>
3142 The packages with this distribution value are deemed
3143 by their maintainers to be high risk. Oftentimes they
3144 represent early beta or developmental packages from
3145 various sources that the maintainers want people to
3146 try, but are not ready to be a part of the other parts
3147 of the Debian distribution tree.
3148 </item>
3149 </taglist>
3152 Others are used for updating stable releases or for
3153 security uploads. More information is available in the
3154 Debian Developer's Reference, section "The Debian
3155 archive".
3156 </p>
3157 </footnote>
3158 The Debian archive software only supports listing a single
3159 distribution. Migration of packages to other distributions is
3160 handled outside of the upload process.
3161 </p>
3162 </sect1>
3164 <sect1 id="f-Date">
3165 <heading><tt>Date</tt></heading>
3168 This field includes the date the package was built or last edited.
3169 </p>
3172 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3173 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3174 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">).
3175 </p>
3176 </sect1>
3178 <sect1 id="f-Format">
3179 <heading><tt>Format</tt></heading>
3182 This field specifies a format revision for the file.
3183 The most current format described in the Policy Manual
3184 is version <strong>1.5</strong>. The syntax of the
3185 format value is the same as that of a package version
3186 number except that no epoch or Debian revision is allowed
3187 - see <ref id="f-Version">.
3188 </p>
3189 </sect1>
3191 <sect1 id="f-Urgency">
3192 <heading><tt>Urgency</tt></heading>
3195 This is a description of how important it is to upgrade to
3196 this version from previous ones. It consists of a single
3197 keyword taking one of the values <tt>low</tt>,
3198 <tt>medium</tt>, <tt>high</tt>, <tt>emergency</tt>, or
3199 <tt>critical</tt><footnote>
3200 Other urgency values are supported with configuration
3201 changes in the archive software but are not used in Debian.
3202 The urgency affects how quickly a package will be considered
3203 for inclusion into the <tt>testing</tt> distribution and
3204 gives an indication of the importance of any fixes included
3205 in the upload. <tt>Emergency</tt> and <tt>critical</tt> are
3206 treated as synonymous.
3207 </footnote> (not case-sensitive) followed by an optional
3208 commentary (separated by a space) which is usually in
3209 parentheses. For example:
3211 <example>
3212 Urgency: low (HIGH for users of diversions)
3213 </example>
3215 </p>
3218 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3219 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3220 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">.
3221 </p>
3222 </sect1>
3224 <sect1 id="f-Changes">
3225 <heading><tt>Changes</tt></heading>
3228 This field contains the human-readable changes data, describing
3229 the differences between the last version and the current one.
3230 </p>
3233 There should be nothing in this field before the first
3234 newline; all the subsequent lines must be indented by at
3235 least one space; blank lines must be represented by a line
3236 consisting only of a space and a full stop.
3237 </p>
3240 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3241 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3242 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">).
3243 </p>
3246 Each version's change information should be preceded by a
3247 "title" line giving at least the version, distribution(s)
3248 and urgency, in a human-readable way.
3249 </p>
3252 If data from several versions is being returned the entry
3253 for the most recent version should be returned first, and
3254 entries should be separated by the representation of a
3255 blank line (the "title" line may also be followed by the
3256 representation of blank line).
3257 </p>
3258 </sect1>
3260 <sect1 id="f-Binary">
3261 <heading><tt>Binary</tt></heading>
3264 This field is a list of binary packages.
3265 </p>
3268 When it appears in the <file>.dsc</file> file it is the list
3269 of binary packages which a source package can produce. It
3270 does not necessarily produce all of these binary packages
3271 for every architecture. The source control file doesn't
3272 contain details of which architectures are appropriate for
3273 which of the binary packages.
3274 </p>
3277 When it appears in a <file>.changes</file> file it lists the
3278 names of the binary packages actually being uploaded.
3279 </p>
3282 The syntax is a list of binary packages separated by
3283 commas<footnote>
3284 A space after each comma is conventional.
3285 </footnote>. Currently the packages must be separated using
3286 only spaces in the <file>.changes</file> file.
3287 </p>
3288 </sect1>
3290 <sect1 id="f-Installed-Size">
3291 <heading><tt>Installed-Size</tt></heading>
3294 This field appears in the control files of binary
3295 packages, and in the <file>Packages</file> files. It gives
3296 the total amount of disk space required to install the
3297 named package.
3298 </p>
3301 The disk space is given as the integer value of the installed
3302 size divided by 1024 (in other words, the size in kibibytes)
3303 and rounded up.
3304 </p>
3305 </sect1>
3307 <sect1 id="f-Files">
3308 <heading><tt>Files</tt></heading>
3311 This field contains a list of files with information about
3312 each one. The exact information and syntax varies with
3313 the context. In all cases the part of the field
3314 contents on the same line as the field name is empty. The
3315 remainder of the field is one line per file, each line
3316 being indented by one space and containing a number of
3317 sub-fields separated by spaces.
3318 </p>
3321 In the <file>.dsc</file> file, each line contains the MD5
3322 checksum, size and filename of the tar file and (if applicable)
3323 diff file which make up the remainder of the source
3324 package<footnote>
3325 That is, the parts which are not the <tt>.dsc</tt>.
3326 </footnote>.
3327 The exact forms of the filenames are described
3328 in <ref id="pkg-sourcearchives">.
3329 </p>
3332 In the <file>.changes</file> file this contains one line per
3333 file being uploaded. Each line contains the MD5 checksum,
3334 size, section and priority and the filename.
3335 The <qref id="f-Section">section</qref>
3336 and <qref id="f-Priority">priority</qref>
3337 are the values of the corresponding fields in
3338 the main source control file. If no section or priority is
3339 specified then <tt>-</tt> should be used, though section
3340 and priority values must be specified for new packages to
3341 be installed properly.
3342 </p>
3345 The special value <tt>byhand</tt> for the section in a
3346 <tt>.changes</tt> file indicates that the file in question
3347 is not an ordinary package file and must by installed by
3348 hand by the distribution maintainers. If the section is
3349 <tt>byhand</tt> the priority should be <tt>-</tt>.
3350 </p>
3353 If a new Debian revision of a package is being shipped and
3354 no new original source archive is being distributed the
3355 <tt>.dsc</tt> must still contain the <tt>Files</tt> field
3356 entry for the original source archive
3357 <file><var>package</var>-<var>upstream-version</var>.orig.tar.gz</file>,
3358 but the <file>.changes</file> file should leave it out. In
3359 this case the original source archive on the distribution
3360 site must match exactly, byte-for-byte, the original
3361 source archive which was used to generate the
3362 <file>.dsc</file> file and diff which are being uploaded.</p>
3363 </sect1>
3365 <sect1 id="f-Closes">
3366 <heading><tt>Closes</tt></heading>
3369 A space-separated list of bug report numbers that the upload
3370 governed by the .changes file closes.
3371 </p>
3372 </sect1>
3374 <sect1 id="f-Homepage">
3375 <heading><tt>Homepage</tt></heading>
3378 The URL of the web site for this package, preferably (when
3379 applicable) the site from which the original source can be
3380 obtained and any additional upstream documentation or
3381 information may be found. The content of this field is a
3382 simple URL without any surrounding characters such as
3383 <tt>&lt;&gt;</tt>.
3384 </p>
3385 </sect1>
3387 </sect>
3389 <sect>
3390 <heading>User-defined fields</heading>
3393 Additional user-defined fields may be added to the
3394 source package control file. Such fields will be
3395 ignored, and not copied to (for example) binary or
3396 source package control files or upload control files.
3397 </p>
3400 If you wish to add additional unsupported fields to
3401 these output files you should use the mechanism
3402 described here.
3403 </p>
3406 Fields in the main source control information file with
3407 names starting <tt>X</tt>, followed by one or more of
3408 the letters <tt>BCS</tt> and a hyphen <tt>-</tt>, will
3409 be copied to the output files. Only the part of the
3410 field name after the hyphen will be used in the output
3411 file. Where the letter <tt>B</tt> is used the field
3412 will appear in binary package control files, where the
3413 letter <tt>S</tt> is used in source package control
3414 files and where <tt>C</tt> is used in upload control
3415 (<tt>.changes</tt>) files.
3416 </p>
3419 For example, if the main source information control file
3420 contains the field
3421 <example>
3422 XBS-Comment: I stand between the candle and the star.
3423 </example>
3424 then the binary and source package control files will contain the
3425 field
3426 <example>
3427 Comment: I stand between the candle and the star.
3428 </example>
3429 </p>
3431 </sect>
3433 </chapt>
3436 <chapt id="maintainerscripts">
3437 <heading>Package maintainer scripts and installation procedure</heading>
3439 <sect>
3440 <heading>Introduction to package maintainer scripts</heading>
3443 It is possible to supply scripts as part of a package which
3444 the package management system will run for you when your
3445 package is installed, upgraded or removed.
3446 </p>
3449 These scripts are the files <prgn>preinst</prgn>,
3450 <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn> and
3451 <prgn>postrm</prgn> in the control area of the package.
3452 They must be proper executable files; if they are scripts
3453 (which is recommended), they must start with the usual
3454 <tt>#!</tt> convention. They should be readable and
3455 executable by anyone, and must not be world-writable.
3456 </p>
3459 The package management system looks at the exit status from
3460 these scripts. It is important that they exit with a
3461 non-zero status if there is an error, so that the package
3462 management system can stop its processing. For shell
3463 scripts this means that you <em>almost always</em> need to
3464 use <tt>set -e</tt> (this is usually true when writing shell
3465 scripts, in fact). It is also important, of course, that
3466 they exit with a zero status if everything went well.
3467 </p>
3470 Additionally, packages interacting with users using
3471 <tt>debconf</tt> in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script should
3472 install a <prgn>config</prgn> script in the control area,
3473 see <ref id="maintscriptprompt"> for details.
3474 </p>
3477 When a package is upgraded a combination of the scripts from
3478 the old and new packages is called during the upgrade
3479 procedure. If your scripts are going to be at all
3480 complicated you need to be aware of this, and may need to
3481 check the arguments to your scripts.
3482 </p>
3485 Broadly speaking the <prgn>preinst</prgn> is called before
3486 (a particular version of) a package is installed, and the
3487 <prgn>postinst</prgn> afterwards; the <prgn>prerm</prgn>
3488 before (a version of) a package is removed and the
3489 <prgn>postrm</prgn> afterwards.
3490 </p>
3493 Programs called from maintainer scripts should not normally
3494 have a path prepended to them. Before installation is
3495 started, the package management system checks to see if the
3496 programs <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>,
3497 <prgn>start-stop-daemon</prgn>, <prgn>install-info</prgn>,
3498 and <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> can be found via the
3499 <tt>PATH</tt> environment variable. Those programs, and any
3500 other program that one would expect to be in the
3501 <tt>PATH</tt>, should thus be invoked without an absolute
3502 pathname. Maintainer scripts should also not reset the
3503 <tt>PATH</tt>, though they might choose to modify it by
3504 prepending or appending package-specific directories. These
3505 considerations really apply to all shell scripts.</p>
3506 </sect>
3508 <sect id="idempotency">
3509 <heading>Maintainer scripts idempotency</heading>
3512 It is necessary for the error recovery procedures that the
3513 scripts be idempotent. This means that if it is run
3514 successfully, and then it is called again, it doesn't bomb
3515 out or cause any harm, but just ensures that everything is
3516 the way it ought to be. If the first call failed, or
3517 aborted half way through for some reason, the second call
3518 should merely do the things that were left undone the first
3519 time, if any, and exit with a success status if everything
3520 is OK.<footnote>
3521 This is so that if an error occurs, the user interrupts
3522 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> or some other unforeseen circumstance
3523 happens you don't leave the user with a badly-broken
3524 package when <prgn>dpkg</prgn> attempts to repeat the
3525 action.
3526 </footnote>
3527 </p>
3528 </sect>
3530 <sect id="controllingterminal">
3531 <heading>Controlling terminal for maintainer scripts</heading>
3534 The maintainer scripts are guaranteed to run with a
3535 controlling terminal and can interact with the user.
3536 Because these scripts may be executed with standard output
3537 redirected into a pipe for logging purposes, Perl scripts
3538 should set unbuffered output by setting <tt>$|=1</tt> so
3539 that the output is printed immediately rather than being
3540 buffered.
3541 </p>
3542 </sect>
3543 <sect id="exitstatus">
3544 <heading>Exit status</heading>
3547 Each script must return a zero exit status for
3548 success, or a nonzero one for failure, since the package
3549 management system looks for the exit status of these scripts
3550 and determines what action to take next based on that datum.
3551 </p>
3552 </sect>
3554 <sect id="mscriptsinstact"><heading>Summary of ways maintainer
3555 scripts are called
3556 </heading>
3559 <list compact="compact">
3560 <item>
3561 <var>new-preinst</var> <tt>install</tt>
3562 </item>
3563 <item>
3564 <var>new-preinst</var> <tt>install</tt> <var>old-version</var>
3565 </item>
3566 <item>
3567 <var>new-preinst</var> <tt>upgrade</tt> <var>old-version</var>
3568 </item>
3569 <item>
3570 <var>old-preinst</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
3571 <var>new-version</var>
3572 </item>
3573 </list>
3576 <list compact="compact">
3577 <item>
3578 <var>postinst</var> <tt>configure</tt>
3579 <var>most-recently-configured-version</var>
3580 </item>
3581 <item>
3582 <var>old-postinst</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
3583 <var>new-version</var>
3584 </item>
3585 <item>
3586 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> <tt>abort-remove</tt>
3587 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package</var>
3588 <var>new-version</var>
3589 </item>
3590 <item>
3591 <var>postinst</var> <tt>abort-remove</tt>
3592 </item>
3593 <item>
3594 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var>
3595 <tt>abort-deconfigure</tt> <tt>in-favour</tt>
3596 <var>failed-install-package</var> <var>version</var>
3597 [<tt>removing</tt> <var>conflicting-package</var>
3598 <var>version</var>]
3599 </item>
3600 </list>
3603 <list compact="compact">
3604 <item>
3605 <var>prerm</var> <tt>remove</tt>
3606 </item>
3607 <item>
3608 <var>old-prerm</var> <tt>upgrade</tt>
3609 <var>new-version</var>
3610 </item>
3611 <item>
3612 <var>new-prerm</var> <tt>failed-upgrade</tt>
3613 <var>old-version</var>
3614 </item>
3615 <item>
3616 <var>conflictor's-prerm</var> <tt>remove</tt>
3617 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package</var>
3618 <var>new-version</var>
3619 </item>
3620 <item>
3621 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> <tt>deconfigure</tt>
3622 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package-being-installed</var>
3623 <var>version</var> [<tt>removing</tt>
3624 <var>conflicting-package</var>
3625 <var>version</var>]
3626 </item>
3627 </list>
3630 <list compact="compact">
3631 <item>
3632 <var>postrm</var> <tt>remove</tt>
3633 </item>
3634 <item>
3635 <var>postrm</var> <tt>purge</tt>
3636 </item>
3637 <item>
3638 <var>old-postrm</var> <tt>upgrade</tt>
3639 <var>new-version</var>
3640 </item>
3641 <item>
3642 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>failed-upgrade</tt>
3643 <var>old-version</var>
3644 </item>
3645 <item>
3646 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-install</tt>
3647 </item>
3648 <item>
3649 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-install</tt>
3650 <var>old-version</var>
3651 </item>
3652 <item>
3653 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
3654 <var>old-version</var>
3655 </item>
3656 <item>
3657 <var>disappearer's-postrm</var> <tt>disappear</tt>
3658 <var>overwriter</var>
3659 <var>overwriter-version</var>
3660 </item>
3661 </list>
3662 </p>
3665 <sect id="unpackphase">
3666 <heading>Details of unpack phase of installation or upgrade</heading>
3669 The procedure on installation/upgrade/overwrite/disappear
3670 (i.e., when running <tt>dpkg --unpack</tt>, or the unpack
3671 stage of <tt>dpkg --install</tt>) is as follows. In each
3672 case, if a major error occurs (unless listed below) the
3673 actions are, in general, run backwards - this means that the
3674 maintainer scripts are run with different arguments in
3675 reverse order. These are the "error unwind" calls listed
3676 below.
3678 <enumlist>
3679 <item>
3680 <enumlist>
3681 <item>
3682 If a version of the package is already installed, call
3683 <example compact="compact">
3684 <var>old-prerm</var> upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3685 </example>
3686 </item>
3687 <item>
3688 If the script runs but exits with a non-zero
3689 exit status, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will attempt:
3690 <example compact="compact">
3691 <var>new-prerm</var> failed-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3692 </example>
3693 If this works, the upgrade continues. If this
3694 does not work, the error unwind:
3695 <example compact="compact">
3696 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3697 </example>
3698 If this works, then the old-version is
3699 "Installed", if not, the old version is in a
3700 "Failed-Config" state.
3701 </item>
3702 </enumlist>
3703 </item>
3705 <item>
3706 If a "conflicting" package is being removed at the same time,
3707 or if any package will be broken (due to <tt>Breaks</tt>):
3708 <enumlist>
3709 <item>
3710 If <tt>--auto-deconfigure</tt> is
3711 specified, call, for each package to be deconfigured
3712 due to <tt>Breaks</tt>:
3713 <example compact="compact">
3714 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> deconfigure \
3715 in-favour <var>package-being-installed</var> <var>version</var>
3716 </example>
3717 Error unwind:
3718 <example compact="compact">
3719 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var> abort-deconfigure \
3720 in-favour <var>package-being-installed-but-failed</var> <var>version</var>
3721 </example>
3722 The deconfigured packages are marked as
3723 requiring configuration, so that if
3724 <tt>--install</tt> is used they will be
3725 configured again if possible.
3726 </item>
3727 <item>
3728 If any packages depended on a conflicting
3729 package being removed and <tt>--auto-deconfigure</tt> is
3730 specified, call, for each such package:
3731 <example compact="compact">
3732 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> deconfigure \
3733 in-favour <var>package-being-installed</var> <var>version</var> \
3734 removing <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>
3735 </example>
3736 Error unwind:
3737 <example compact="compact">
3738 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var> abort-deconfigure \
3739 in-favour <var>package-being-installed-but-failed</var> <var>version</var> \
3740 removing <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>
3741 </example>
3742 The deconfigured packages are marked as
3743 requiring configuration, so that if
3744 <tt>--install</tt> is used they will be
3745 configured again if possible.
3746 </item>
3747 <item>
3748 To prepare for removal of each conflicting package, call:
3749 <example compact="compact">
3750 <var>conflictor's-prerm</var> remove \
3751 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
3752 </example>
3753 Error unwind:
3754 <example compact="compact">
3755 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> abort-remove \
3756 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
3757 </example>
3758 </item>
3759 </enumlist>
3760 </item>
3762 <item>
3763 <enumlist>
3764 <item>
3765 If the package is being upgraded, call:
3766 <example compact="compact">
3767 <var>new-preinst</var> upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3768 </example>
3769 If this fails, we call:
3770 <example>
3771 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3772 </example>
3773 <enumlist>
3774 <item>
3776 If that works, then
3777 <example>
3778 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3779 </example>
3780 is called. If this works, then the old version
3781 is in an "Installed" state, or else it is left
3782 in an "Unpacked" state.
3783 </p>
3784 </item>
3785 <item>
3787 If it fails, then the old version is left
3788 in an "Half-Installed" state.
3789 </p>
3790 </item>
3791 </enumlist>
3793 </item>
3794 <item>
3795 Otherwise, if the package had some configuration
3796 files from a previous version installed (i.e., it
3797 is in the "configuration files only" state):
3798 <example compact="compact">
3799 <var>new-preinst</var> install <var>old-version</var>
3800 </example>
3801 Error unwind:
3802 <example>
3803 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-install <var>old-version</var>
3804 </example>
3805 If this fails, the package is left in a
3806 "Half-Installed" state, which requires a
3807 reinstall. If it works, the packages is left in
3808 a "Config Files" state.
3809 </item>
3810 <item>
3811 Otherwise (i.e., the package was completely purged):
3812 <example compact="compact">
3813 <var>new-preinst</var> install
3814 </example>
3815 Error unwind:
3816 <example compact="compact">
3817 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-install
3818 </example>
3819 If the error-unwind fails, the package is in a
3820 "Half Installed" phase, and requires a
3821 reinstall. If the error unwind works, the
3822 package is in a not installed state.
3823 </item>
3824 </enumlist>
3825 </item>
3827 <item>
3829 The new package's files are unpacked, overwriting any
3830 that may be on the system already, for example any
3831 from the old version of the same package or from
3832 another package. Backups of the old files are kept
3833 temporarily, and if anything goes wrong the package
3834 management system will attempt to put them back as
3835 part of the error unwind.
3836 </p>
3839 It is an error for a package to contain files which
3840 are on the system in another package, unless
3841 <tt>Replaces</tt> is used (see <ref id="replaces">).
3842 <!--
3843 The following paragraph is not currently the case:
3844 Currently the <tt>- - force-overwrite</tt> flag is
3845 enabled, downgrading it to a warning, but this may not
3846 always be the case.
3848 </p>
3851 It is a more serious error for a package to contain a
3852 plain file or other kind of non-directory where another
3853 package has a directory (again, unless
3854 <tt>Replaces</tt> is used). This error can be
3855 overridden if desired using
3856 <tt>--force-overwrite-dir</tt>, but this is not
3857 advisable.
3858 </p>
3861 Packages which overwrite each other's files produce
3862 behavior which, though deterministic, is hard for the
3863 system administrator to understand. It can easily
3864 lead to "missing" programs if, for example, a package
3865 is installed which overwrites a file from another
3866 package, and is then removed again.<footnote>
3867 Part of the problem is due to what is arguably a
3868 bug in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>.
3869 </footnote>
3870 </p>
3873 A directory will never be replaced by a symbolic link
3874 to a directory or vice versa; instead, the existing
3875 state (symlink or not) will be left alone and
3876 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will follow the symlink if there is
3877 one.
3878 </p>
3879 </item>
3881 <item>
3883 <enumlist>
3884 <item>
3885 If the package is being upgraded, call
3886 <example compact="compact">
3887 <var>old-postrm</var> upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3888 </example>
3889 </item>
3890 <item>
3891 If this fails, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will attempt:
3892 <example compact="compact">
3893 <var>new-postrm</var> failed-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3894 </example>
3895 If this works, installation continues. If not,
3896 Error unwind:
3897 <example compact="compact">
3898 <var>old-preinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3899 </example>
3900 If this fails, the old version is left in an
3901 "Half Installed" state. If it works, dpkg now
3902 calls:
3903 <example compact="compact">
3904 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3905 </example>
3906 If this fails, the old version is left in an
3907 "Half Installed" state. If it works, dpkg now
3908 calls:
3909 <example compact="compact">
3910 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3911 </example>
3912 If this fails, the old version is in an
3913 "Unpacked" state.
3914 </item>
3915 </enumlist>
3916 </p>
3919 This is the point of no return - if
3920 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> gets this far, it won't back off
3921 past this point if an error occurs. This will
3922 leave the package in a fairly bad state, which
3923 will require a successful re-installation to clear
3924 up, but it's when <prgn>dpkg</prgn> starts doing
3925 things that are irreversible.
3926 </p>
3927 </item>
3929 <item>
3930 Any files which were in the old version of the package
3931 but not in the new are removed.
3932 </item>
3934 <item>
3935 The new file list replaces the old.
3936 </item>
3938 <item>
3939 The new maintainer scripts replace the old.
3940 </item>
3942 <item>
3943 Any packages all of whose files have been overwritten
3944 during the installation, and which aren't required for
3945 dependencies, are considered to have been removed.
3946 For each such package
3947 <enumlist>
3948 <item>
3949 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> calls:
3950 <example compact="compact">
3951 <var>disappearer's-postrm</var> disappear \
3952 <var>overwriter</var> <var>overwriter-version</var>
3953 </example>
3954 </item>
3955 <item>
3956 The package's maintainer scripts are removed.
3957 </item>
3958 <item>
3959 It is noted in the status database as being in a
3960 sane state, namely not installed (any conffiles
3961 it may have are ignored, rather than being
3962 removed by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>). Note that
3963 disappearing packages do not have their prerm
3964 called, because <prgn>dpkg</prgn> doesn't know
3965 in advance that the package is going to
3966 vanish.
3967 </item>
3968 </enumlist>
3969 </item>
3971 <item>
3972 Any files in the package we're unpacking that are also
3973 listed in the file lists of other packages are removed
3974 from those lists. (This will lobotomize the file list
3975 of the "conflicting" package if there is one.)
3976 </item>
3978 <item>
3979 The backup files made during installation, above, are
3980 deleted.
3981 </item>
3983 <item>
3985 The new package's status is now sane, and recorded as
3986 "unpacked".
3987 </p>
3990 Here is another point of no return - if the
3991 conflicting package's removal fails we do not unwind
3992 the rest of the installation; the conflicting package
3993 is left in a half-removed limbo.
3994 </p>
3995 </item>
3997 <item>
3998 If there was a conflicting package we go and do the
3999 removal actions (described below), starting with the
4000 removal of the conflicting package's files (any that
4001 are also in the package being installed have already
4002 been removed from the conflicting package's file list,
4003 and so do not get removed now).
4004 </item>
4005 </enumlist>
4006 </p>
4007 </sect>
4009 <sect id="configdetails"><heading>Details of configuration</heading>
4012 When we configure a package (this happens with <tt>dpkg
4013 --install</tt> and <tt>dpkg --configure</tt>), we first
4014 update any <tt>conffile</tt>s and then call:
4015 <example compact="compact">
4016 <var>postinst</var> configure <var>most-recently-configured-version</var>
4017 </example>
4018 </p>
4021 No attempt is made to unwind after errors during
4022 configuration. If the configuration fails, the package is in
4023 a "Failed Config" state, and an error message is generated.
4024 </p>
4027 If there is no most recently configured version
4028 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will pass a null argument.
4029 <footnote>
4031 Historical note: Truly ancient (pre-1997) versions of
4032 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> passed <tt>&lt;unknown&gt;</tt>
4033 (including the angle brackets) in this case. Even older
4034 ones did not pass a second argument at all, under any
4035 circumstance. Note that upgrades using such an old dpkg
4036 version are unlikely to work for other reasons, even if
4037 this old argument behavior is handled by your postinst script.
4038 </p>
4039 </footnote>
4040 </p>
4041 </sect>
4043 <sect id="removedetails"><heading>Details of removal and/or
4044 configuration purging</heading>
4047 <enumlist>
4048 <item>
4050 <example compact="compact">
4051 <var>prerm</var> remove
4052 </example>
4053 </p>
4055 If prerm fails during replacement due to conflict
4056 <example>
4057 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> abort-remove \
4058 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
4059 </example>
4060 Or else we call:
4061 <example>
4062 <var>postinst</var> abort-remove
4063 </example>
4064 </p>
4066 If this fails, the package is in a "Failed-Config"
4067 state, or else it remains "Installed".
4068 </p>
4069 </item>
4070 <item>
4071 The package's files are removed (except <tt>conffile</tt>s).
4072 </item>
4073 <item>
4074 <example compact="compact">
4075 <var>postrm</var> remove
4076 </example>
4079 If it fails, there's no error unwind, and the package is in
4080 an "Half-Installed" state.
4081 </p>
4082 </item>
4083 <item>
4085 All the maintainer scripts except the <prgn>postrm</prgn>
4086 are removed.
4087 </p>
4090 If we aren't purging the package we stop here. Note
4091 that packages which have no <prgn>postrm</prgn> and no
4092 <tt>conffile</tt>s are automatically purged when
4093 removed, as there is no difference except for the
4094 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> status.
4095 </p>
4096 </item>
4097 <item>
4098 The <tt>conffile</tt>s and any backup files
4099 (<tt>~</tt>-files, <tt>#*#</tt> files,
4100 <tt>%</tt>-files, <tt>.dpkg-{old,new,tmp}</tt>, etc.)
4101 are removed.
4102 </item>
4103 <item>
4105 <example compact="compact">
4106 <var>postrm</var> purge
4107 </example>
4108 </p>
4110 If this fails, the package remains in a "Config-Files"
4111 state.
4112 </p>
4113 </item>
4114 <item>
4115 The package's file list is removed.
4116 </item>
4117 </enumlist>
4119 </p>
4120 </sect>
4121 </chapt>
4124 <chapt id="relationships">
4125 <heading>Declaring relationships between packages</heading>
4127 <sect id="depsyntax">
4128 <heading>Syntax of relationship fields</heading>
4131 These fields all have a uniform syntax. They are a list of
4132 package names separated by commas.
4133 </p>
4136 In the <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Recommends</tt>,
4137 <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
4138 <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>
4139 control file fields of the package, which declare
4140 dependencies on other packages, the package names listed may
4141 also include lists of alternative package names, separated
4142 by vertical bar (pipe) symbols <tt>|</tt>. In such a case,
4143 if any one of the alternative packages is installed, that
4144 part of the dependency is considered to be satisfied.
4145 </p>
4148 All of the fields except for <tt>Provides</tt> may restrict
4149 their applicability to particular versions of each named
4150 package. This is done in parentheses after each individual
4151 package name; the parentheses should contain a relation from
4152 the list below followed by a version number, in the format
4153 described in <ref id="f-Version">.
4154 </p>
4157 The relations allowed are <tt>&lt;&lt;</tt>, <tt>&lt;=</tt>,
4158 <tt>=</tt>, <tt>&gt;=</tt> and <tt>&gt;&gt;</tt> for
4159 strictly earlier, earlier or equal, exactly equal, later or
4160 equal and strictly later, respectively. The deprecated
4161 forms <tt>&lt;</tt> and <tt>&gt;</tt> were used to mean
4162 earlier/later or equal, rather than strictly earlier/later,
4163 so they should not appear in new packages (though
4164 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> still supports them).
4165 </p>
4168 Whitespace may appear at any point in the version
4169 specification subject to the rules in <ref
4170 id="controlsyntax">, and must appear where it's necessary to
4171 disambiguate; it is not otherwise significant. All of the
4172 relationship fields may span multiple lines. For
4173 consistency and in case of future changes to
4174 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> it is recommended that a single space be
4175 used after a version relationship and before a version
4176 number; it is also conventional to put a single space after
4177 each comma, on either side of each vertical bar, and before
4178 each open parenthesis. When wrapping a relationship field, it
4179 is conventional to do so after a comma and before the space
4180 following that comma.
4181 </p>
4184 For example, a list of dependencies might appear as:
4185 <example compact="compact">
4186 Package: mutt
4187 Version: 1.3.17-1
4188 Depends: libc6 (>= 2.2.1), exim | mail-transport-agent
4189 </example>
4190 </p>
4193 All fields that specify build-time relationships
4194 (<tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4195 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>)
4196 may be restricted to a certain set of architectures. This
4197 is indicated in brackets after each individual package name and
4198 the optional version specification. The brackets enclose a
4199 list of Debian architecture names separated by whitespace.
4200 Exclamation marks may be prepended to each of the names.
4201 (It is not permitted for some names to be prepended with
4202 exclamation marks while others aren't.) If the current Debian
4203 host architecture is not in this list and there are no
4204 exclamation marks in the list, or it is in the list with a
4205 prepended exclamation mark, the package name and the
4206 associated version specification are ignored completely for
4207 the purposes of defining the relationships.
4208 </p>
4211 For example:
4212 <example compact="compact">
4213 Source: glibc
4214 Build-Depends-Indep: texinfo
4215 Build-Depends: kernel-headers-2.2.10 [!hurd-i386],
4216 hurd-dev [hurd-i386], gnumach-dev [hurd-i386]
4217 </example>
4218 requires <tt>kernel-headers-2.2.10</tt> on all architectures
4219 other than hurd-i386 and requires <tt>hurd-dev</tt> and
4220 <tt>gnumach-dev</tt> only on hurd-i386.
4221 </p>
4224 If the architecture-restricted dependency is part of a set of
4225 alternatives using <tt>|</tt>, that alternative is ignored
4226 completely on architectures that do not match the restriction.
4227 For example:
4228 <example compact="compact">
4229 Build-Depends: foo [!i386] | bar [!amd64]
4230 </example>
4231 is equivalent to <tt>bar</tt> on the i386 architecture, to
4232 <tt>foo</tt> on the amd64 architecture, and to <tt>foo |
4233 bar</tt> on all other architectures.
4234 </p>
4237 Note that the binary package relationship fields such as
4238 <tt>Depends</tt> appear in one of the binary package
4239 sections of the control file, whereas the build-time
4240 relationships such as <tt>Build-Depends</tt> appear in the
4241 source package section of the control file (which is the
4242 first section).
4243 </p>
4244 </sect>
4246 <sect id="binarydeps">
4247 <heading>Binary Dependencies - <tt>Depends</tt>,
4248 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4249 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>
4250 </heading>
4253 Packages can declare in their control file that they have
4254 certain relationships to other packages - for example, that
4255 they may not be installed at the same time as certain other
4256 packages, and/or that they depend on the presence of others.
4257 </p>
4260 This is done using the <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
4261 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4262 <tt>Breaks</tt> and <tt>Conflicts</tt> control file fields.
4263 <tt>Breaks</tt> is described in <ref id="breaks">, and
4264 <tt>Conflicts</tt> is described in <ref id="conflicts">. The
4265 rest are described below.
4266 </p>
4269 These seven fields are used to declare a dependency
4270 relationship by one package on another. Except for
4271 <tt>Enhances</tt> and <tt>Breaks</tt>, they appear in the
4272 depending (binary) package's control file.
4273 (<tt>Enhances</tt> appears in the recommending package's
4274 control file, and <tt>Breaks</tt> appears in the version of
4275 depended-on package which causes the named package to
4276 break).
4277 </p>
4280 A <tt>Depends</tt> field takes effect <em>only</em> when a
4281 package is to be configured. It does not prevent a package
4282 being on the system in an unconfigured state while its
4283 dependencies are unsatisfied, and it is possible to replace
4284 a package whose dependencies are satisfied and which is
4285 properly installed with a different version whose
4286 dependencies are not and cannot be satisfied; when this is
4287 done the depending package will be left unconfigured (since
4288 attempts to configure it will give errors) and will not
4289 function properly. If it is necessary, a
4290 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> field can be used, which has a partial
4291 effect even when a package is being unpacked, as explained
4292 in detail below. (The other three dependency fields,
4293 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt> and
4294 <tt>Enhances</tt>, are only used by the various front-ends
4295 to <prgn>dpkg</prgn> such as <prgn>apt-get</prgn>,
4296 <prgn>aptitude</prgn>, and <prgn>dselect</prgn>.)
4297 </p>
4300 For this reason packages in an installation run are usually
4301 all unpacked first and all configured later; this gives
4302 later versions of packages with dependencies on later
4303 versions of other packages the opportunity to have their
4304 dependencies satisfied.
4305 </p>
4308 In case of circular dependencies, since installation or
4309 removal order honoring the dependency order can't be
4310 established, dependency loops are broken at some point
4311 (based on rules below), and some packages may not be able to
4312 rely on their dependencies being present when being
4313 installed or removed, depending on which side of the break
4314 of the circular dependency loop they happen to be on. If one
4315 of the packages in the loop has no postinst script, then the
4316 cycle will be broken at that package, so as to ensure that
4317 all postinst scripts run with the dependencies properly
4318 configured if this is possible. Otherwise the breaking point
4319 is arbitrary.
4320 </p>
4323 The <tt>Depends</tt> field thus allows package maintainers
4324 to impose an order in which packages should be configured.
4325 </p>
4328 The meaning of the five dependency fields is as follows:
4329 <taglist>
4330 <tag><tt>Depends</tt></tag>
4331 <item>
4333 This declares an absolute dependency. A package will
4334 not be configured unless all of the packages listed in
4335 its <tt>Depends</tt> field have been correctly
4336 configured.
4337 </p>
4340 The <tt>Depends</tt> field should be used if the
4341 depended-on package is required for the depending
4342 package to provide a significant amount of
4343 functionality.
4344 </p>
4347 The <tt>Depends</tt> field should also be used if the
4348 <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn> or
4349 <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts require the package to be
4350 present in order to run. Note, however, that the
4351 <prgn>postrm</prgn> cannot rely on any non-essential
4352 packages to be present during the <tt>purge</tt>
4353 phase.
4354 </item>
4356 <tag><tt>Recommends</tt></tag>
4357 <item>
4359 This declares a strong, but not absolute, dependency.
4360 </p>
4363 The <tt>Recommends</tt> field should list packages
4364 that would be found together with this one in all but
4365 unusual installations.
4366 </p>
4367 </item>
4369 <tag><tt>Suggests</tt></tag>
4370 <item>
4371 This is used to declare that one package may be more
4372 useful with one or more others. Using this field
4373 tells the packaging system and the user that the
4374 listed packages are related to this one and can
4375 perhaps enhance its usefulness, but that installing
4376 this one without them is perfectly reasonable.
4377 </item>
4379 <tag><tt>Enhances</tt></tag>
4380 <item>
4381 This field is similar to Suggests but works in the
4382 opposite direction. It is used to declare that a
4383 package can enhance the functionality of another
4384 package.
4385 </item>
4387 <tag><tt>Pre-Depends</tt></tag>
4388 <item>
4390 This field is like <tt>Depends</tt>, except that it
4391 also forces <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to complete installation
4392 of the packages named before even starting the
4393 installation of the package which declares the
4394 pre-dependency, as follows:
4395 </p>
4398 When a package declaring a pre-dependency is about to
4399 be <em>unpacked</em> the pre-dependency can be
4400 satisfied if the depended-on package is either fully
4401 configured, <em>or even if</em> the depended-on
4402 package(s) are only unpacked or half-configured,
4403 provided that they have been configured correctly at
4404 some point in the past (and not removed or partially
4405 removed since). In this case, both the
4406 previously-configured and currently unpacked or
4407 half-configured versions must satisfy any version
4408 clause in the <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> field.
4409 </p>
4412 When the package declaring a pre-dependency is about
4413 to be <em>configured</em>, the pre-dependency will be
4414 treated as a normal <tt>Depends</tt>, that is, it will
4415 be considered satisfied only if the depended-on
4416 package has been correctly configured.
4417 </p>
4420 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> should be used sparingly,
4421 preferably only by packages whose premature upgrade or
4422 installation would hamper the ability of the system to
4423 continue with any upgrade that might be in progress.
4424 </p>
4427 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> are also required if the
4428 <prgn>preinst</prgn> script depends on the named
4429 package. It is best to avoid this situation if
4430 possible.
4431 </p>
4432 </item>
4433 </taglist>
4434 </p>
4437 When selecting which level of dependency to use you should
4438 consider how important the depended-on package is to the
4439 functionality of the one declaring the dependency. Some
4440 packages are composed of components of varying degrees of
4441 importance. Such a package should list using
4442 <tt>Depends</tt> the package(s) which are required by the
4443 more important components. The other components'
4444 requirements may be mentioned as Suggestions or
4445 Recommendations, as appropriate to the components' relative
4446 importance.
4447 </p>
4448 </sect>
4450 <sect id="breaks">
4451 <heading>Packages which break other packages - <tt>Breaks</tt></heading>
4454 When one binary package declares that it breaks another,
4455 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will refuse to allow the package which
4456 declares <tt>Breaks</tt> be installed unless the broken
4457 package is deconfigured first, and it will refuse to
4458 allow the broken package to be reconfigured.
4459 </p>
4462 A package will not be regarded as causing breakage merely
4463 because its configuration files are still installed; it must
4464 be at least half-installed.
4465 </p>
4468 A special exception is made for packages which declare that
4469 they break their own package name or a virtual package which
4470 they provide (see below): this does not count as a real
4471 breakage.
4472 </p>
4475 Normally a <tt>Breaks</tt> entry will have an "earlier than"
4476 version clause; such a <tt>Breaks</tt> is introduced in the
4477 version of an (implicit or explicit) dependency which
4478 violates an assumption or reveals a bug in earlier versions
4479 of the broken package. This use of <tt>Breaks</tt> will
4480 inform higher-level package management tools that broken
4481 package must be upgraded before the new one.
4482 </p>
4485 If the breaking package also overwrites some files from the
4486 older package, it should use <tt>Replaces</tt> (not
4487 <tt>Conflicts</tt>) to ensure this goes smoothly.
4488 </p>
4489 </sect>
4491 <sect id="conflicts">
4492 <heading>Conflicting binary packages - <tt>Conflicts</tt></heading>
4495 When one binary package declares a conflict with another
4496 using a <tt>Conflicts</tt> field, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will
4497 refuse to allow them to be installed on the system at the
4498 same time.
4499 </p>
4502 If one package is to be installed, the other must be removed
4503 first - if the package being installed is marked as
4504 replacing (see <ref id="replaces">) the one on the system,
4505 or the one on the system is marked as deselected, or both
4506 packages are marked <tt>Essential</tt>, then
4507 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will automatically remove the package
4508 which is causing the conflict, otherwise it will halt the
4509 installation of the new package with an error. This
4510 mechanism is specifically designed to produce an error when
4511 the installed package is <tt>Essential</tt>, but the new
4512 package is not.
4513 </p>
4516 A package will not cause a conflict merely because its
4517 configuration files are still installed; it must be at least
4518 half-installed.
4519 </p>
4522 A special exception is made for packages which declare a
4523 conflict with their own package name, or with a virtual
4524 package which they provide (see below): this does not
4525 prevent their installation, and allows a package to conflict
4526 with others providing a replacement for it. You use this
4527 feature when you want the package in question to be the only
4528 package providing some feature.
4529 </p>
4532 A <tt>Conflicts</tt> entry should almost never have an
4533 "earlier than" version clause. This would prevent
4534 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> from upgrading or installing the package
4535 which declared such a conflict until the upgrade or removal
4536 of the conflicted-with package had been completed. Instead,
4537 <tt>Breaks</tt> may be used.
4538 </p>
4539 </sect>
4541 <sect id="virtual"><heading>Virtual packages - <tt>Provides</tt>
4542 </heading>
4545 As well as the names of actual ("concrete") packages, the
4546 package relationship fields <tt>Depends</tt>,
4547 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4548 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>, <tt>Breaks</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt>,
4549 <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4550 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>
4551 may mention "virtual packages".
4552 </p>
4555 A <em>virtual package</em> is one which appears in the
4556 <tt>Provides</tt> control file field of another package.
4557 The effect is as if the package(s) which provide a
4558 particular virtual package name had been listed by name
4559 everywhere the virtual package name appears. (See also <ref
4560 id="virtual_pkg">)
4561 </p>
4564 If there are both concrete and virtual packages of the same
4565 name, then the dependency may be satisfied (or the conflict
4566 caused) by either the concrete package with the name in
4567 question or any other concrete package which provides the
4568 virtual package with the name in question. This is so that,
4569 for example, supposing we have
4570 <example compact="compact">
4571 Package: foo
4572 Depends: bar
4573 </example> and someone else releases an enhanced version of
4574 the <tt>bar</tt> package they can say:
4575 <example compact="compact">
4576 Package: bar-plus
4577 Provides: bar
4578 </example>
4579 and the <tt>bar-plus</tt> package will now also satisfy the
4580 dependency for the <tt>foo</tt> package.
4581 </p>
4584 If a relationship field has a version number attached
4585 then only real packages will be considered to see whether
4586 the relationship is satisfied (or the prohibition violated,
4587 for a conflict or breakage) - it is assumed that a real
4588 package which provides the virtual package is not of the
4589 "right" version. So, a <tt>Provides</tt> field may not
4590 contain version numbers, and the version number of the
4591 concrete package which provides a particular virtual package
4592 will not be looked at when considering a dependency on or
4593 conflict with the virtual package name.
4594 </p>
4597 It is likely that the ability will be added in a future
4598 release of <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to specify a version number for
4599 each virtual package it provides. This feature is not yet
4600 present, however, and is expected to be used only
4601 infrequently.
4602 </p>
4605 If you want to specify which of a set of real packages
4606 should be the default to satisfy a particular dependency on
4607 a virtual package, you should list the real package as an
4608 alternative before the virtual one.
4609 </p>
4610 </sect>
4613 <sect id="replaces"><heading>Overwriting files and replacing
4614 packages - <tt>Replaces</tt></heading>
4617 Packages can declare in their control file that they should
4618 overwrite files in certain other packages, or completely
4619 replace other packages. The <tt>Replaces</tt> control file
4620 field has these two distinct purposes.
4621 </p>
4623 <sect1><heading>Overwriting files in other packages</heading>
4626 Firstly, as mentioned before, it is usually an error for a
4627 package to contain files which are on the system in
4628 another package.
4629 </p>
4632 However, if the overwriting package declares that it
4633 <tt>Replaces</tt> the one containing the file being
4634 overwritten, then <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will replace the file
4635 from the old package with that from the new. The file
4636 will no longer be listed as "owned" by the old package.
4637 </p>
4640 If a package is completely replaced in this way, so that
4641 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> does not know of any files it still
4642 contains, it is considered to have "disappeared". It will
4643 be marked as not wanted on the system (selected for
4644 removal) and not installed. Any <tt>conffile</tt>s
4645 details noted for the package will be ignored, as they
4646 will have been taken over by the overwriting package. The
4647 package's <prgn>postrm</prgn> script will be run with a
4648 special argument to allow the package to do any final
4649 cleanup required. See <ref id="mscriptsinstact">.
4650 <footnote>
4652 Replaces is a one way relationship -- you have to
4653 install the replacing package after the replaced
4654 package.
4655 </p>
4656 </footnote>
4657 </p>
4660 For this usage of <tt>Replaces</tt>, virtual packages (see
4661 <ref id="virtual">) are not considered when looking at a
4662 <tt>Replaces</tt> field - the packages declared as being
4663 replaced must be mentioned by their real names.
4664 </p>
4667 Furthermore, this usage of <tt>Replaces</tt> only takes
4668 effect when both packages are at least partially on the
4669 system at once, so that it can only happen if they do not
4670 conflict or if the conflict has been overridden.
4671 </p>
4673 </sect1>
4675 <sect1><heading>Replacing whole packages, forcing their
4676 removal</heading>
4679 Secondly, <tt>Replaces</tt> allows the packaging system to
4680 resolve which package should be removed when there is a
4681 conflict - see <ref id="conflicts">. This usage only
4682 takes effect when the two packages <em>do</em> conflict,
4683 so that the two usages of this field do not interfere with
4684 each other.
4685 </p>
4688 In this situation, the package declared as being replaced
4689 can be a virtual package, so for example, all mail
4690 transport agents (MTAs) would have the following fields in
4691 their control files:
4692 <example compact="compact">
4693 Provides: mail-transport-agent
4694 Conflicts: mail-transport-agent
4695 Replaces: mail-transport-agent
4696 </example>
4697 ensuring that only one MTA can be installed at any one
4698 time.
4699 </sect1>
4700 </sect>
4702 <sect id="sourcebinarydeps">
4703 <heading>Relationships between source and binary packages -
4704 <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4705 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>
4706 </heading>
4709 Source packages that require certain binary packages to be
4710 installed or absent at the time of building the package
4711 can declare relationships to those binary packages.
4712 </p>
4715 This is done using the <tt>Build-Depends</tt>,
4716 <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and
4717 <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt> control file fields.
4718 </p>
4721 Build-dependencies on "build-essential" binary packages can be
4722 omitted. Please see <ref id="pkg-relations"> for more information.
4723 </p>
4726 The dependencies and conflicts they define must be satisfied
4727 (as defined earlier for binary packages) in order to invoke
4728 the targets in <tt>debian/rules</tt>, as follows:<footnote>
4730 If you make "build-arch" or "binary-arch", you need
4731 Build-Depends. If you make "build-indep" or
4732 "binary-indep", you need Build-Depends and
4733 Build-Depends-Indep. If you make "build" or "binary",
4734 you need both.
4735 </p>
4737 There is no Build-Depends-Arch; this role is essentially
4738 met with Build-Depends. Anyone building the
4739 <tt>build-indep</tt> and binary-indep<tt></tt> targets
4740 is basically assumed to be building the whole package
4741 anyway and so installs all build dependencies. The
4742 autobuilders use <tt>dpkg-buildpackage -B</tt>, which
4743 calls <tt>build</tt> (not <tt>build-arch</tt>, since it
4744 does not yet know how to check for its existence) and
4745 <tt>binary-arch</tt>.
4746 </p>
4748 The purpose of the original split, I recall, was so that
4749 the autobuilders wouldn't need to install extra packages
4750 needed only for the binary-indep targets. But without a
4751 build-arch/build-indep split, this didn't work, since
4752 most of the work is done in the build target, not in the
4753 binary target.
4754 </p>
4755 </footnote>
4757 <taglist>
4758 <tag><tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt></tag>
4759 <item>
4760 The <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and
4761 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> fields must be satisfied when
4762 any of the following targets is invoked:
4763 <tt>build</tt>, <tt>clean</tt>, <tt>binary</tt>,
4764 <tt>binary-arch</tt>, <tt>build-arch</tt>,
4765 <tt>build-indep</tt> and <tt>binary-indep</tt>.
4766 </item>
4767 <tag><tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4768 <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt></tag>
4769 <item>
4770 The <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt> and
4771 <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt> fields must be
4772 satisfied when any of the following targets is
4773 invoked: <tt>build</tt>, <tt>build-indep</tt>,
4774 <tt>binary</tt> and <tt>binary-indep</tt>.
4775 </item>
4776 </taglist>
4777 </p>
4779 </sect>
4781 </chapt>
4784 <chapt id="sharedlibs"><heading>Shared libraries</heading>
4787 Packages containing shared libraries must be constructed with
4788 a little care to make sure that the shared library is always
4789 available. This is especially important for packages whose
4790 shared libraries are vitally important, such as the C library
4791 (currently <tt>libc6</tt>).
4792 </p>
4795 Packages involving shared libraries should be split up into
4796 several binary packages. This section mostly deals with how
4797 this separation is to be accomplished; rules for files within
4798 the shared library packages are in <ref id="libraries"> instead.
4799 </p>
4801 <sect id="sharedlibs-runtime">
4802 <heading>Run-time shared libraries</heading>
4805 The run-time shared library needs to be placed in a package
4806 whose name changes whenever the shared object version
4807 changes.<footnote>
4809 Since it is common place to install several versions of a
4810 package that just provides shared libraries, it is a
4811 good idea that the library package should not
4812 contain any extraneous non-versioned files, unless they
4813 happen to be in versioned directories.</p>
4814 </footnote>
4815 The most common mechanism is to place it in a package
4816 called
4817 <package><var>libraryname</var><var>soversion</var></package>,
4818 where <file><var>soversion</var></file> is the version number
4819 in the soname of the shared library<footnote>
4820 The soname is the shared object name: it's the thing
4821 that has to match exactly between building an executable
4822 and running it for the dynamic linker to be able run the
4823 program. For example, if the soname of the library is
4824 <file>libfoo.so.6</file>, the library package would be
4825 called <file>libfoo6</file>.
4826 </footnote>.
4827 Alternatively, if it would be confusing to directly append
4828 <var>soversion</var> to <var>libraryname</var> (e.g. because
4829 <var>libraryname</var> itself ends in a number), you may use
4830 <package><var>libraryname</var>-<var>soversion</var></package> and
4831 <package><var>libraryname</var>-<var>soversion</var>-dev</package>
4832 instead.
4833 </p>
4836 If you have several shared libraries built from the same
4837 source tree you may lump them all together into a single
4838 shared library package, provided that you change all of
4839 their sonames at once (so that you don't get filename
4840 clashes if you try to install different versions of the
4841 combined shared libraries package).
4842 </p>
4845 The package should install the shared libraries under
4846 their normal names. For example, the <package>libgdbm3</package>
4847 package should install <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file> as
4848 <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. The files should not be
4849 renamed or re-linked by any <prgn>prerm</prgn> or
4850 <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts; <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will take care
4851 of renaming things safely without affecting running programs,
4852 and attempts to interfere with this are likely to lead to
4853 problems.
4854 </p>
4857 Shared libraries should not be installed executable, since
4858 the dynamic linker does not require this and trying to
4859 execute a shared library usually results in a core dump.
4860 </p>
4863 The run-time library package should include the symbolic link that
4864 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> would create for the shared libraries.
4865 For example, the <package>libgdbm3</package> package should include
4866 a symbolic link from <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so.3</file> to
4867 <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. This is needed so that the dynamic
4868 linker (for example <prgn>ld.so</prgn> or
4869 <prgn>ld-linux.so.*</prgn>) can find the library between the
4870 time that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> installs it and the time that
4871 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> is run in the <prgn>postinst</prgn>
4872 script.<footnote>
4873 The package management system requires the library to be
4874 placed before the symbolic link pointing to it in the
4875 <file>.deb</file> file. This is so that when
4876 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> comes to install the symlink
4877 (overwriting the previous symlink pointing at an older
4878 version of the library), the new shared library is already
4879 in place. In the past, this was achieved by creating the
4880 library in the temporary packaging directory before
4881 creating the symlink. Unfortunately, this was not always
4882 effective, since the building of the tar file in the
4883 <file>.deb</file> depended on the behavior of the underlying
4884 file system. Some file systems (such as reiserfs) reorder
4885 the files so that the order of creation is forgotten.
4886 Since version 1.7.0, <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
4887 reorders the files itself as necessary when building a
4888 package. Thus it is no longer important to concern
4889 oneself with the order of file creation.
4890 </footnote>
4891 </p>
4893 <sect1 id="ldconfig">
4894 <heading><tt>ldconfig</tt></heading>
4897 Any package installing shared libraries in one of the default
4898 library directories of the dynamic linker (which are currently
4899 <file>/usr/lib</file> and <file>/lib</file>) or a directory that is
4900 listed in <file>/etc/ld.so.conf</file><footnote>
4901 These are currently
4902 <list compact="compact">
4903 <item>/usr/local/lib</item>
4904 <item>/usr/lib/libc5-compat</item>
4905 <item>/lib/libc5-compat</item>
4906 </list>
4907 </footnote>
4908 must use <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> to update the shared library
4909 system.
4910 </p>
4913 The package maintainer scripts must only call
4914 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> under these circumstances:
4915 <list compact="compact">
4916 <item>When the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script is run with a
4917 first argument of <tt>configure</tt>, the script must call
4918 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>, and may optionally invoke
4919 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> at other times.
4920 </item>
4921 <item>When the <prgn>postrm</prgn> script is run with a
4922 first argument of <tt>remove</tt>, the script should call
4923 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>.
4924 </item>
4925 </list>
4926 <footnote>
4928 During install or upgrade, the preinst is called before
4929 the new files are installed, so calling "ldconfig" is
4930 pointless. The preinst of an existing package can also be
4931 called if an upgrade fails. However, this happens during
4932 the critical time when a shared libs may exist on-disk
4933 under a temporary name. Thus, it is dangerous and
4934 forbidden by current policy to call "ldconfig" at this
4935 time.
4936 </p>
4939 When a package is installed or upgraded, "postinst
4940 configure" runs after the new files are safely on-disk.
4941 Since it is perfectly safe to invoke ldconfig
4942 unconditionally in a postinst, it is OK for a package to
4943 simply put ldconfig in its postinst without checking the
4944 argument. The postinst can also be called to recover from
4945 a failed upgrade. This happens before any new files are
4946 unpacked, so there is no reason to call "ldconfig" at this
4947 point.
4948 </p>
4951 For a package that is being removed, prerm is
4952 called with all the files intact, so calling ldconfig is
4953 useless. The other calls to "prerm" happen in the case of
4954 upgrade at a time when all the files of the old package
4955 are on-disk, so again calling "ldconfig" is pointless.
4956 </p>
4959 postrm, on the other hand, is called with the "remove"
4960 argument just after the files are removed, so this is
4961 the proper time to call "ldconfig" to notify the system
4962 of the fact that the shared libraries from the package
4963 are removed. The postrm can be called at several other
4964 times. At the time of "postrm purge", "postrm
4965 abort-install", or "postrm abort-upgrade", calling
4966 "ldconfig" is useless because the shared lib files are
4967 not on-disk. However, when "postrm" is invoked with
4968 arguments "upgrade", "failed-upgrade", or "disappear", a
4969 shared lib may exist on-disk under a temporary filename.
4970 </p>
4971 </footnote>
4972 </p>
4973 </sect1>
4975 </sect>
4977 <sect id="sharedlibs-support-files">
4978 <heading>Shared library support files</heading>
4981 If your package contains files whose names do not change with
4982 each change in the library shared object version, you must not
4983 put them in the shared library package. Otherwise, several
4984 versions of the shared library cannot be installed at the same
4985 time without filename clashes, making upgrades and transitions
4986 unnecessarily difficult.
4987 </p>
4990 It is recommended that supporting files and run-time support
4991 programs that do not need to be invoked manually by users, but
4992 are nevertheless required for the package to function, be placed
4993 (if they are binary) in a subdirectory of <file>/usr/lib</file>,
4994 preferably under <file>/usr/lib/</file><var>package-name</var>.
4995 If the program or file is architecture independent, the
4996 recommendation is for it to be placed in a subdirectory of
4997 <file>/usr/share</file> instead, preferably under
4998 <file>/usr/share/</file><var>package-name</var>. Following the
4999 <var>package-name</var> naming convention ensures that the file
5000 names change when the shared object version changes.
5001 </p>
5004 Run-time support programs that use the shared library but are
5005 not required for the library to function or files used by the
5006 shared library that can be used by any version of the shared
5007 library package should instead be put in a separate package.
5008 This package might typically be named
5009 <package><var>libraryname</var>-tools</package>; note the
5010 absence of the <var>soversion</var> in the package name.
5011 </p>
5014 Files and support programs only useful when compiling software
5015 against the library should be included in the development
5016 package for the library.<footnote>
5017 For example, a <file><var>package-name</var>-config</file>
5018 script or <package>pkg-config</package> configuration files.
5019 </footnote>
5020 </p>
5021 </sect>
5023 <sect id="sharedlibs-static">
5024 <heading>Static libraries</heading>
5027 The static library (<file><var>libraryname.a</var></file>)
5028 is usually provided in addition to the shared version.
5029 It is placed into the development package (see below).
5030 </p>
5033 In some cases, it is acceptable for a library to be
5034 available in static form only; these cases include:
5035 <list>
5036 <item>libraries for languages whose shared library support
5037 is immature or unstable</item>
5038 <item>libraries whose interfaces are in flux or under
5039 development (commonly the case when the library's
5040 major version number is zero, or where the ABI breaks
5041 across patchlevels)</item>
5042 <item>libraries which are explicitly intended to be
5043 available only in static form by their upstream
5044 author(s)</item>
5045 </list>
5046 </p>
5048 <sect id="sharedlibs-dev">
5049 <heading>Development files</heading>
5052 The development files associated to a shared library need to be
5053 placed in a package called
5054 <package><var>libraryname</var><var>soversion</var>-dev</package>,
5055 or if you prefer only to support one development version at a
5056 time, <package><var>libraryname</var>-dev</package>.
5057 </p>
5060 In case several development versions of a library exist, you may
5061 need to use <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s Conflicts mechanism (see
5062 <ref id="conflicts">) to ensure that the user only installs one
5063 development version at a time (as different development versions are
5064 likely to have the same header files in them, which would cause a
5065 filename clash if both were installed).
5066 </p>
5069 The development package should contain a symlink for the associated
5070 shared library without a version number. For example, the
5071 <package>libgdbm-dev</package> package should include a symlink
5072 from <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so</file> to
5073 <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. This symlink is needed by the linker
5074 (<prgn>ld</prgn>) when compiling packages, as it will only look for
5075 <file>libgdbm.so</file> when compiling dynamically.
5076 </p>
5077 </sect>
5079 <sect id="sharedlibs-intradeps">
5080 <heading>Dependencies between the packages of the same library</heading>
5083 Typically the development version should have an exact
5084 version dependency on the runtime library, to make sure that
5085 compilation and linking happens correctly. The
5086 <tt>${binary:Version}</tt> substitution variable can be
5087 useful for this purpose.
5088 <footnote>
5089 Previously, <tt>${Source-Version}</tt> was used, but its name
5090 was confusing and it has been deprecated since dpkg 1.13.19.
5091 </footnote>
5092 </p>
5093 </sect>
5095 <sect id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps">
5096 <heading>Dependencies between the library and other packages -
5097 the <tt>shlibs</tt> system</heading>
5100 If a package contains a binary or library which links to a
5101 shared library, we must ensure that when the package is
5102 installed on the system, all of the libraries needed are
5103 also installed. This requirement led to the creation of the
5104 <tt>shlibs</tt> system, which is very simple in its design:
5105 any package which <em>provides</em> a shared library also
5106 provides information on the package dependencies required to
5107 ensure the presence of this library, and any package which
5108 <em>uses</em> a shared library uses this information to
5109 determine the dependencies it requires. The files which
5110 contain the mapping from shared libraries to the necessary
5111 dependency information are called <file>shlibs</file> files.
5112 </p>
5115 Thus, when a package is built which contains any shared
5116 libraries, it must provide a <file>shlibs</file> file for other
5117 packages to use, and when a package is built which contains
5118 any shared libraries or compiled binaries, it must run
5119 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>
5120 on these to determine the libraries used and hence the
5121 dependencies needed by this package.<footnote>
5123 In the past, the shared libraries linked to were
5124 determined by calling <prgn>ldd</prgn>, but now
5125 <prgn>objdump</prgn> is used to do this. The only
5126 change this makes to package building is that
5127 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> must also be run on shared
5128 libraries, whereas in the past this was unnecessary.
5129 The rest of this footnote explains the advantage that
5130 this method gives.
5131 </p>
5134 We say that a binary <tt>foo</tt> <em>directly</em> uses
5135 a library <tt>libbar</tt> if it is explicitly linked
5136 with that library (that is, it uses the flag
5137 <tt>-lbar</tt> during the linking stage). Other
5138 libraries that are needed by <tt>libbar</tt> are linked
5139 <em>indirectly</em> to <tt>foo</tt>, and the dynamic
5140 linker will load them automatically when it loads
5141 <tt>libbar</tt>. A package should depend on
5142 the libraries it directly uses, and the dependencies for
5143 those libraries should automatically pull in the other
5144 libraries.
5145 </p>
5148 Unfortunately, the <prgn>ldd</prgn> program shows both
5149 the directly and indirectly used libraries, meaning that
5150 the dependencies determined included both direct and
5151 indirect dependencies. The use of <prgn>objdump</prgn>
5152 avoids this problem by determining only the directly
5153 used libraries.
5154 </p>
5157 A good example of where this helps is the following. We
5158 could update <tt>libimlib</tt> with a new version that
5159 supports a new graphics format called dgf (but retaining
5160 the same major version number). If we used the old
5161 <prgn>ldd</prgn> method, every package that uses
5162 <tt>libimlib</tt> would need to be recompiled so it
5163 would also depend on <tt>libdgf</tt> or it wouldn't run
5164 due to missing symbols. However with the new system,
5165 packages using <tt>libimlib</tt> can rely on
5166 <tt>libimlib</tt> itself having the dependency on
5167 <tt>libdgf</tt> and so they would not need rebuilding.
5168 </p>
5169 </footnote>
5170 </p>
5173 In the following sections, we will first describe where the
5174 various <tt>shlibs</tt> files are to be found, then how to
5175 use <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>, and finally the <tt>shlibs</tt>
5176 file format and how to create them if your package contains a
5177 shared library.
5178 </p>
5180 <sect1>
5181 <heading>The <tt>shlibs</tt> files present on the system</heading>
5184 There are several places where <tt>shlibs</tt> files are
5185 found. The following list gives them in the order in which
5186 they are read by
5187 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>.
5188 (The first one which gives the required information is used.)
5189 </p>
5192 <list>
5193 <item>
5194 <p><file>debian/shlibs.local</file></p>
5197 This lists overrides for this package. Its use is
5198 described below (see <ref id="shlibslocal">).
5199 </p>
5200 </item>
5202 <item>
5203 <p><file>/etc/dpkg/shlibs.override</file></p>
5206 This lists global overrides. This list is normally
5207 empty. It is maintained by the local system
5208 administrator.
5209 </p>
5210 </item>
5212 <item>
5213 <p><file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files in the "build directory"</p>
5216 When packages are being built, any
5217 <file>debian/shlibs</file> files are copied into the
5218 control file area of the temporary build directory and
5219 given the name <file>shlibs</file>. These files give
5220 details of any shared libraries included in the
5221 package.<footnote>
5222 An example may help here. Let us say that the
5223 source package <tt>foo</tt> generates two binary
5224 packages, <tt>libfoo2</tt> and
5225 <tt>foo-runtime</tt>. When building the binary
5226 packages, the two packages are created in the
5227 directories <file>debian/libfoo2</file> and
5228 <file>debian/foo-runtime</file> respectively.
5229 (<file>debian/tmp</file> could be used instead of one
5230 of these.) Since <tt>libfoo2</tt> provides the
5231 <tt>libfoo</tt> shared library, it will require a
5232 <tt>shlibs</tt> file, which will be installed in
5233 <file>debian/libfoo2/DEBIAN/shlibs</file>, eventually
5234 to become
5235 <file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/libfoo2.shlibs</file>. Then
5236 when <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> is run on the
5237 executable
5238 <file>debian/foo-runtime/usr/bin/foo-prog</file>, it
5239 will examine the
5240 <file>debian/libfoo2/DEBIAN/shlibs</file> file to
5241 determine whether <tt>foo-prog</tt>'s library
5242 dependencies are satisfied by any of the libraries
5243 provided by <tt>libfoo2</tt>. For this reason,
5244 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> must only be run once
5245 all of the individual binary packages'
5246 <tt>shlibs</tt> files have been installed into the
5247 build directory.
5248 </footnote>
5249 </p>
5250 </item>
5252 <item>
5253 <p><file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/*.shlibs</file></p>
5256 These are the <file>shlibs</file> files corresponding to
5257 all of the packages installed on the system, and are
5258 maintained by the relevant package maintainers.
5259 </p>
5260 </item>
5262 <item>
5263 <p><file>/etc/dpkg/shlibs.default</file></p>
5266 This file lists any shared libraries whose packages
5267 have failed to provide correct <file>shlibs</file> files.
5268 It was used when the <file>shlibs</file> setup was first
5269 introduced, but it is now normally empty. It is
5270 maintained by the <tt>dpkg</tt> maintainer.
5271 </p>
5272 </item>
5273 </list>
5274 </p>
5275 </sect1>
5277 <sect1>
5278 <heading>How to use <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> and the
5279 <file>shlibs</file> files</heading>
5282 Put a call to
5283 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>
5284 into your <file>debian/rules</file> file. If your package
5285 contains only compiled binaries and libraries (but no scripts),
5286 you can use a command such as:
5287 <example compact="compact">
5288 dpkg-shlibdeps debian/tmp/usr/bin/* debian/tmp/usr/sbin/* \
5289 debian/tmp/usr/lib/*
5290 </example>
5291 Otherwise, you will need to explicitly list the compiled
5292 binaries and libraries.<footnote>
5293 If you are using <tt>debhelper</tt>, the
5294 <prgn>dh_shlibdeps</prgn> program will do this work for
5295 you. It will also correctly handle multi-binary
5296 packages.
5297 </footnote>
5298 </p>
5301 This command puts the dependency information into the
5302 <file>debian/substvars</file> file, which is then used by
5303 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>. You will need to place a
5304 <tt>${shlibs:Depends}</tt> variable in the <tt>Depends</tt>
5305 field in the control file for this to work.
5306 </p>
5309 If <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> doesn't complain, you're
5310 done. If it does complain you might need to create your own
5311 <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file, as explained below (see
5312 <ref id="shlibslocal">).
5313 </p>
5316 If you have multiple binary packages, you will need to call
5317 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> on each one which contains
5318 compiled libraries or binaries. In such a case, you will
5319 need to use the <tt>-T</tt> option to the <tt>dpkg</tt>
5320 utilities to specify a different <file>substvars</file> file.
5321 </p>
5324 If you are creating a udeb for use in the Debian Installer, you
5325 will need to specify that <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> should use
5326 the dependency line of type <tt>udeb</tt> by adding
5327 <tt>-tudeb</tt> as option<footnote>
5328 <prgn>dh_shlibdeps</prgn> from the <tt>debhelper</tt> suite
5329 will automatically add this option if it knows it is
5330 processing a udeb.
5331 </footnote>. If there is no dependency line of type <tt>udeb</tt>
5332 in the <file>shlibs</file> file, <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> will
5333 fall back to the regular dependency line.
5334 </p>
5337 For more details on dpkg-shlibdeps, please see
5338 <ref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"> and
5339 <manref name="dpkg-shlibdeps" section="1">.
5340 </p>
5341 </sect1>
5343 <sect1 id="shlibs">
5344 <heading>The <file>shlibs</file> File Format</heading>
5347 Each <file>shlibs</file> file has the same format. Lines
5348 beginning with <tt>#</tt> are considered to be comments and
5349 are ignored. Each line is of the form:
5350 <example compact="compact">
5351 [<var>type</var>: ]<var>library-name</var> <var>soname-version</var> <var>dependencies ...</var>
5352 </example>
5353 </p>
5356 We will explain this by reference to the example of the
5357 <tt>zlib1g</tt> package, which (at the time of writing)
5358 installs the shared library <file>/usr/lib/libz.so.1.1.3</file>.
5359 </p>
5362 <var>type</var> is an optional element that indicates the type
5363 of package for which the line is valid. The only type currently
5364 in use is <tt>udeb</tt>. The colon and space after the type are
5365 required.
5366 </p>
5369 <var>library-name</var> is the name of the shared library,
5370 in this case <tt>libz</tt>. (This must match the name part
5371 of the soname, see below.)
5372 </p>
5375 <var>soname-version</var> is the version part of the soname of
5376 the library. The soname is the thing that must exactly match
5377 for the library to be recognized by the dynamic linker, and is
5378 usually of the form
5379 <tt><var>name</var>.so.<var>major-version</var></tt>, in our
5380 example, <tt>libz.so.1</tt>.<footnote>
5381 This can be determined using the command
5382 <example compact="compact">
5383 objdump -p /usr/lib/libz.so.1.1.3 | grep SONAME
5384 </example>
5385 </footnote>
5386 The version part is the part which comes after
5387 <tt>.so.</tt>, so in our case, it is <tt>1</tt>.
5388 </p>
5391 <var>dependencies</var> has the same syntax as a dependency
5392 field in a binary package control file. It should give
5393 details of which packages are required to satisfy a binary
5394 built against the version of the library contained in the
5395 package. See <ref id="depsyntax"> for details.
5396 </p>
5399 In our example, if the first version of the <tt>zlib1g</tt>
5400 package which contained a minor number of at least
5401 <tt>1.3</tt> was <var>1:1.1.3-1</var>, then the
5402 <tt>shlibs</tt> entry for this library could say:
5403 <example compact="compact">
5404 libz 1 zlib1g (>= 1:1.1.3)
5405 </example>
5406 The version-specific dependency is to avoid warnings from
5407 the dynamic linker about using older shared libraries with
5408 newer binaries.
5409 </p>
5412 As zlib1g also provides a udeb containing the shared library,
5413 there would also be a second line:
5414 <example compact="compact">
5415 udeb: libz 1 zlib1g-udeb (>= 1:1.1.3)
5416 </example>
5417 </p>
5418 </sect1>
5420 <sect1>
5421 <heading>Providing a <file>shlibs</file> file</heading>
5424 If your package provides a shared library, you need to create
5425 a <file>shlibs</file> file following the format described above.
5426 It is usual to call this file <file>debian/shlibs</file> (but if
5427 you have multiple binary packages, you might want to call it
5428 <file>debian/shlibs.<var>package</var></file> instead). Then
5429 let <file>debian/rules</file> install it in the control area:
5430 <example compact="compact">
5431 install -m644 debian/shlibs debian/tmp/DEBIAN
5432 </example>
5433 or, in the case of a multi-binary package:
5434 <example compact="compact">
5435 install -m644 debian/shlibs.<var>package</var> debian/<var>package</var>/DEBIAN/shlibs
5436 </example>
5437 An alternative way of doing this is to create the
5438 <file>shlibs</file> file in the control area directly from
5439 <file>debian/rules</file> without using a <file>debian/shlibs</file>
5440 file at all,<footnote>
5441 This is what <prgn>dh_makeshlibs</prgn> in the
5442 <tt>debhelper</tt> suite does. If your package also has a udeb
5443 that provides a shared library, <prgn>dh_makeshlibs</prgn> can
5444 automatically generate the <tt>udeb:</tt> lines if you specify
5445 the name of the udeb with the <tt>--add-udeb</tt> option.
5446 </footnote>
5447 since the <file>debian/shlibs</file> file itself is ignored by
5448 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>.
5449 </p>
5452 As <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> reads the
5453 <file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files in all of the binary packages
5454 being built from this source package, all of the
5455 <file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files should be installed before
5456 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> is called on any of the binary
5457 packages.
5458 </p>
5459 </sect1>
5461 <sect1 id="shlibslocal">
5462 <heading>Writing the <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file</heading>
5465 This file is intended only as a <em>temporary</em> fix if
5466 your binaries or libraries depend on a library whose package
5467 does not yet provide a correct <file>shlibs</file> file.
5468 </p>
5471 We will assume that you are trying to package a binary
5472 <tt>foo</tt>. When you try running
5473 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> you get the following error
5474 message (<tt>-O</tt> displays the dependency information on
5475 <tt>stdout</tt> instead of writing it to
5476 <tt>debian/substvars</tt>, and the lines have been wrapped
5477 for ease of reading):
5478 <example compact="compact">
5479 $ dpkg-shlibdeps -O debian/tmp/usr/bin/foo
5480 dpkg-shlibdeps: warning: unable to find dependency
5481 information for shared library libbar (soname 1,
5482 path /usr/lib/libbar.so.1, dependency field Depends)
5483 shlibs:Depends=libc6 (>= 2.2.2-2)
5484 </example>
5485 You can then run <prgn>ldd</prgn> on the binary to find the
5486 full location of the library concerned:
5487 <example compact="compact">
5488 $ ldd foo
5489 libbar.so.1 => /usr/lib/libbar.so.1 (0x4001e000)
5490 libc.so.6 => /lib/libc.so.6 (0x40032000)
5491 /lib/ld-linux.so.2 => /lib/ld-linux.so.2 (0x40000000)
5492 </example>
5493 So the <prgn>foo</prgn> binary depends on the
5494 <prgn>libbar</prgn> shared library, but no package seems to
5495 provide a <file>*.shlibs</file> file handling
5496 <file>libbar.so.1</file> in <file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/</file>. Let's
5497 determine the package responsible:
5498 <example compact="compact">
5499 $ dpkg -S /usr/lib/libbar.so.1
5500 bar1: /usr/lib/libbar.so.1
5501 $ dpkg -s bar1 | grep Version
5502 Version: 1.0-1
5503 </example>
5504 This tells us that the <tt>bar1</tt> package, version 1.0-1,
5505 is the one we are using. Now we can file a bug against the
5506 <tt>bar1</tt> package and create our own
5507 <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> to locally fix the problem.
5508 Including the following line into your
5509 <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file:
5510 <example compact="compact">
5511 libbar 1 bar1 (>= 1.0-1)
5512 </example>
5513 should allow the package build to work.
5514 </p>
5517 As soon as the maintainer of <tt>bar1</tt> provides a
5518 correct <file>shlibs</file> file, you should remove this line
5519 from your <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file. (You should
5520 probably also then have a versioned <tt>Build-Depends</tt>
5521 on <tt>bar1</tt> to help ensure that others do not have the
5522 same problem building your package.)
5523 </p>
5524 </sect1>
5526 </sect>
5528 </chapt>
5531 <chapt id="opersys"><heading>The Operating System</heading>
5533 <sect>
5534 <heading>File system hierarchy</heading>
5537 <sect1 id="fhs">
5538 <heading>File System Structure</heading>
5541 The location of all installed files and directories must
5542 comply with the Filesystem Hierarchy Standard (FHS),
5543 version 2.3, with the exceptions noted below, and except
5544 where doing so would violate other terms of Debian
5545 Policy. The following exceptions to the FHS apply:
5547 <enumlist>
5548 <item>
5550 The optional rules related to user specific
5551 configuration files for applications are stored in
5552 the user's home directory are relaxed. It is
5553 recommended that such files start with the
5554 '<tt>.</tt>' character (a "dot file"), and if an
5555 application needs to create more than one dot file
5556 then the preferred placement is in a subdirectory
5557 with a name starting with a '.' character, (a "dot
5558 directory"). In this case it is recommended the
5559 configuration files not start with the '.'
5560 character.
5561 </p>
5562 </item>
5563 <item>
5565 The requirement for amd64 to use <file>/lib64</file>
5566 for 64 bit binaries is removed.
5567 </p>
5568 </item>
5569 <item>
5571 The requirement that
5572 <file>/usr/local/share/man</file> be "synonymous"
5573 with <file>/usr/local/man</file> is relaxed to a
5574 recommendation</p>
5575 </item>
5576 <item>
5578 The requirement that windowmanagers with a single
5579 configuration file call it <file>system.*wmrc</file>
5580 is removed, as is the restriction that the window
5581 manager subdirectory be named identically to the
5582 window manager name itself.
5583 </p>
5584 </item>
5585 <item>
5587 The requirement that boot manager configuration
5588 files live in <file>/etc</file>, or at least are
5589 symlinked there, is relaxed to a recommendation.
5590 </p>
5591 </item>
5592 </enumlist>
5594 </p>
5596 The version of this document referred here can be
5597 found in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package or on <url
5598 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/fhs/"
5599 name="FHS (Debian copy)"> alongside this manual (or, if
5600 you have the <package>debian-policy</package> installed,
5601 you can try <url
5602 id="file:///usr/share/doc/debian-policy/fhs/" name="FHS
5603 (local copy)">). The
5604 latest version, which may be a more recent version, may
5605 be found on
5606 <url id="http://www.pathname.com/fhs/" name="FHS (upstream)">.
5607 Specific questions about following the standard may be
5608 asked on the <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list, or
5609 referred to the FHS mailing list (see the
5610 <url id="http://www.pathname.com/fhs/" name="FHS web site"> for
5611 more information).
5612 </p>
5613 </sect1>
5615 <sect1>
5616 <heading>Site-specific programs</heading>
5619 As mandated by the FHS, packages must not place any
5620 files in <file>/usr/local</file>, either by putting them in
5621 the file system archive to be unpacked by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
5622 or by manipulating them in their maintainer scripts.
5623 </p>
5626 However, the package may create empty directories below
5627 <file>/usr/local</file> so that the system administrator knows
5628 where to place site-specific files. These are not
5629 directories <em>in</em> <file>/usr/local</file>, but are
5630 children of directories in <file>/usr/local</file>. These
5631 directories (<file>/usr/local/*/dir/</file>)
5632 should be removed on package removal if they are
5633 empty.
5634 </p>
5637 Note, that this applies only to directories <em>below</em>
5638 <file>/usr/local</file>, not <em>in</em> <file>/usr/local</file>.
5639 Packages must not create sub-directories in the directory
5640 <file>/usr/local</file> itself, except those listed in FHS,
5641 section 4.5. However, you may create directories below
5642 them as you wish. You must not remove any of the
5643 directories listed in 4.5, even if you created them.
5644 </p>
5647 Since <file>/usr/local</file> can be mounted read-only from a
5648 remote server, these directories must be created and
5649 removed by the <prgn>postinst</prgn> and <prgn>prerm</prgn>
5650 maintainer scripts and not be included in the
5651 <file>.deb</file> archive. These scripts must not fail if
5652 either of these operations fail.
5653 </p>
5656 For example, the <tt>emacsen-common</tt> package could
5657 contain something like
5658 <example compact="compact">
5659 if [ ! -e /usr/local/share/emacs ]
5660 then
5661 if mkdir /usr/local/share/emacs 2>/dev/null
5662 then
5663 chown root:staff /usr/local/share/emacs
5664 chmod 2775 /usr/local/share/emacs
5667 </example>
5668 in its <prgn>postinst</prgn> script, and
5669 <example compact="compact">
5670 rmdir /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp 2>/dev/null || true
5671 rmdir /usr/local/share/emacs 2>/dev/null || true
5672 </example>
5673 in the <prgn>prerm</prgn> script. (Note that this form is
5674 used to ensure that if the script is interrupted, the
5675 directory <file>/usr/local/share/emacs</file> will still be
5676 removed.)
5677 </p>
5680 If you do create a directory in <file>/usr/local</file> for
5681 local additions to a package, you should ensure that
5682 settings in <file>/usr/local</file> take precedence over the
5683 equivalents in <file>/usr</file>.
5684 </p>
5687 However, because <file>/usr/local</file> and its contents are
5688 for exclusive use of the local administrator, a package
5689 must not rely on the presence or absence of files or
5690 directories in <file>/usr/local</file> for normal operation.
5691 </p>
5694 The <file>/usr/local</file> directory itself and all the
5695 subdirectories created by the package should (by default) have
5696 permissions 2775 (group-writable and set-group-id) and be
5697 owned by <tt>root:staff</tt>.
5698 </p>
5699 </sect1>
5701 <sect1>
5702 <heading>The system-wide mail directory</heading>
5704 The system-wide mail directory is <file>/var/mail</file>. This
5705 directory is part of the base system and should not owned
5706 by any particular mail agents. The use of the old
5707 location <file>/var/spool/mail</file> is deprecated, even
5708 though the spool may still be physically located there.
5709 </p>
5710 </sect1>
5711 </sect>
5713 <sect>
5714 <heading>Users and groups</heading>
5716 <sect1>
5717 <heading>Introduction</heading>
5719 The Debian system can be configured to use either plain or
5720 shadow passwords.
5721 </p>
5724 Some user ids (UIDs) and group ids (GIDs) are reserved
5725 globally for use by certain packages. Because some
5726 packages need to include files which are owned by these
5727 users or groups, or need the ids compiled into binaries,
5728 these ids must be used on any Debian system only for the
5729 purpose for which they are allocated. This is a serious
5730 restriction, and we should avoid getting in the way of
5731 local administration policies. In particular, many sites
5732 allocate users and/or local system groups starting at 100.
5733 </p>
5736 Apart from this we should have dynamically allocated ids,
5737 which should by default be arranged in some sensible
5738 order, but the behavior should be configurable.
5739 </p>
5742 Packages other than <tt>base-passwd</tt> must not modify
5743 <file>/etc/passwd</file>, <file>/etc/shadow</file>,
5744 <file>/etc/group</file> or <file>/etc/gshadow</file>.
5745 </p>
5746 </sect1>
5748 <sect1>
5749 <heading>UID and GID classes</heading>
5751 The UID and GID numbers are divided into classes as
5752 follows:
5753 <taglist>
5754 <tag>0-99:</tag>
5755 <item>
5757 Globally allocated by the Debian project, the same
5758 on every Debian system. These ids will appear in
5759 the <file>passwd</file> and <file>group</file> files of all
5760 Debian systems, new ids in this range being added
5761 automatically as the <tt>base-passwd</tt> package is
5762 updated.
5763 </p>
5766 Packages which need a single statically allocated
5767 uid or gid should use one of these; their
5768 maintainers should ask the <tt>base-passwd</tt>
5769 maintainer for ids.
5770 </p>
5771 </item>
5773 <tag>100-999:</tag>
5774 <item>
5776 Dynamically allocated system users and groups.
5777 Packages which need a user or group, but can have
5778 this user or group allocated dynamically and
5779 differently on each system, should use <tt>adduser
5780 --system</tt> to create the group and/or user.
5781 <prgn>adduser</prgn> will check for the existence of
5782 the user or group, and if necessary choose an unused
5783 id based on the ranges specified in
5784 <file>adduser.conf</file>.
5785 </p>
5786 </item>
5788 <tag>1000-29999:</tag>
5789 <item>
5791 Dynamically allocated user accounts. By default
5792 <prgn>adduser</prgn> will choose UIDs and GIDs for
5793 user accounts in this range, though
5794 <file>adduser.conf</file> may be used to modify this
5795 behavior.
5796 </p>
5797 </item>
5799 <tag>30000-59999:</tag>
5800 <item>
5801 <p>Reserved.</p>
5802 </item>
5804 <tag>60000-64999:</tag>
5805 <item>
5807 Globally allocated by the Debian project, but only
5808 created on demand. The ids are allocated centrally
5809 and statically, but the actual accounts are only
5810 created on users' systems on demand.
5811 </p>
5814 These ids are for packages which are obscure or
5815 which require many statically-allocated ids. These
5816 packages should check for and create the accounts in
5817 <file>/etc/passwd</file> or <file>/etc/group</file> (using
5818 <prgn>adduser</prgn> if it has this facility) if
5819 necessary. Packages which are likely to require
5820 further allocations should have a "hole" left after
5821 them in the allocation, to give them room to
5822 grow.
5823 </p>
5824 </item>
5826 <tag>65000-65533:</tag>
5827 <item>
5828 <p>Reserved.</p>
5829 </item>
5831 <tag>65534:</tag>
5832 <item>
5834 User <tt>nobody</tt>. The corresponding gid refers
5835 to the group <tt>nogroup</tt>.
5836 </p>
5837 </item>
5839 <tag>65535:</tag>
5840 <item>
5842 <tt>(uid_t)(-1) == (gid_t)(-1)</tt> <em>must
5843 not</em> be used, because it is the error return
5844 sentinel value.
5845 </p>
5846 </item>
5847 </taglist>
5848 </p>
5849 </sect1>
5850 </sect>
5852 <sect id="sysvinit">
5853 <heading>System run levels and <file>init.d</file> scripts</heading>
5855 <sect1 id="/etc/init.d">
5856 <heading>Introduction</heading>
5859 The <file>/etc/init.d</file> directory contains the scripts
5860 executed by <prgn>init</prgn> at boot time and when the
5861 init state (or "runlevel") is changed (see <manref
5862 name="init" section="8">).
5863 </p>
5866 There are at least two different, yet functionally
5867 equivalent, ways of handling these scripts. For the sake
5868 of simplicity, this document describes only the symbolic
5869 link method. However, it must not be assumed by maintainer
5870 scripts that this method is being used, and any automated
5871 manipulation of the various runlevel behaviors by
5872 maintainer scripts must be performed using
5873 <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> as described below and not by
5874 manually installing or removing symlinks. For information
5875 on the implementation details of the other method,
5876 implemented in the <tt>file-rc</tt> package, please refer
5877 to the documentation of that package.
5878 </p>
5881 These scripts are referenced by symbolic links in the
5882 <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directories. When changing
5883 runlevels, <prgn>init</prgn> looks in the directory
5884 <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> for the scripts it should
5885 execute, where <tt><var>n</var></tt> is the runlevel that
5886 is being changed to, or <tt>S</tt> for the boot-up
5887 scripts.
5888 </p>
5891 The names of the links all have the form
5892 <file>S<var>mm</var><var>script</var></file> or
5893 <file>K<var>mm</var><var>script</var></file> where
5894 <var>mm</var> is a two-digit number and <var>script</var>
5895 is the name of the script (this should be the same as the
5896 name of the actual script in <file>/etc/init.d</file>).
5897 </p>
5900 When <prgn>init</prgn> changes runlevel first the targets
5901 of the links whose names start with a <tt>K</tt> are
5902 executed, each with the single argument <tt>stop</tt>,
5903 followed by the scripts prefixed with an <tt>S</tt>, each
5904 with the single argument <tt>start</tt>. (The links are
5905 those in the <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directory
5906 corresponding to the new runlevel.) The <tt>K</tt> links
5907 are responsible for killing services and the <tt>S</tt>
5908 link for starting services upon entering the runlevel.
5909 </p>
5912 For example, if we are changing from runlevel 2 to
5913 runlevel 3, init will first execute all of the <tt>K</tt>
5914 prefixed scripts it finds in <file>/etc/rc3.d</file>, and then
5915 all of the <tt>S</tt> prefixed scripts in that directory.
5916 The links starting with <tt>K</tt> will cause the
5917 referred-to file to be executed with an argument of
5918 <tt>stop</tt>, and the <tt>S</tt> links with an argument
5919 of <tt>start</tt>.
5920 </p>
5923 The two-digit number <var>mm</var> is used to determine
5924 the order in which to run the scripts: low-numbered links
5925 have their scripts run first. For example, the
5926 <tt>K20</tt> scripts will be executed before the
5927 <tt>K30</tt> scripts. This is used when a certain service
5928 must be started before another. For example, the name
5929 server <prgn>bind</prgn> might need to be started before
5930 the news server <prgn>inn</prgn> so that <prgn>inn</prgn>
5931 can set up its access lists. In this case, the script
5932 that starts <prgn>bind</prgn> would have a lower number
5933 than the script that starts <prgn>inn</prgn> so that it
5934 runs first:
5935 <example compact="compact">
5936 /etc/rc2.d/S17bind
5937 /etc/rc2.d/S70inn
5938 </example>
5939 </p>
5942 The two runlevels 0 (halt) and 6 (reboot) are slightly
5943 different. In these runlevels, the links with an
5944 <tt>S</tt> prefix are still called after those with a
5945 <tt>K</tt> prefix, but they too are called with the single
5946 argument <tt>stop</tt>.
5947 </p>
5948 </sect1>
5950 <sect1>
5951 <heading>Writing the scripts</heading>
5954 Packages that include daemons for system services should
5955 place scripts in <file>/etc/init.d</file> to start or stop
5956 services at boot time or during a change of runlevel.
5957 These scripts should be named
5958 <file>/etc/init.d/<var>package</var></file>, and they should
5959 accept one argument, saying what to do:
5961 <taglist>
5962 <tag><tt>start</tt></tag>
5963 <item>start the service,</item>
5965 <tag><tt>stop</tt></tag>
5966 <item>stop the service,</item>
5968 <tag><tt>restart</tt></tag>
5969 <item>stop and restart the service if it's already running,
5970 otherwise start the service</item>
5972 <tag><tt>reload</tt></tag>
5973 <item><p>cause the configuration of the service to be
5974 reloaded without actually stopping and restarting
5975 the service,</item>
5977 <tag><tt>force-reload</tt></tag>
5978 <item>cause the configuration to be reloaded if the
5979 service supports this, otherwise restart the
5980 service.</item>
5981 </taglist>
5983 The <tt>start</tt>, <tt>stop</tt>, <tt>restart</tt>, and
5984 <tt>force-reload</tt> options should be supported by all
5985 scripts in <file>/etc/init.d</file>, the <tt>reload</tt>
5986 option is optional.
5987 </p>
5990 The <file>init.d</file> scripts must ensure that they will
5991 behave sensibly (i.e., returning success and not starting
5992 multiple copies of a service) if invoked with <tt>start</tt>
5993 when the service is already running, or with <tt>stop</tt>
5994 when it isn't, and that they don't kill unfortunately-named
5995 user processes. The best way to achieve this is usually to
5996 use <prgn>start-stop-daemon</prgn> with the <tt>--oknodo</tt>
5997 option.
5998 </p>
6001 If a service reloads its configuration automatically (as
6002 in the case of <prgn>cron</prgn>, for example), the
6003 <tt>reload</tt> option of the <file>init.d</file> script
6004 should behave as if the configuration has been reloaded
6005 successfully.
6006 </p>
6009 The <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts must be treated as
6010 configuration files, either (if they are present in the
6011 package, that is, in the .deb file) by marking them as
6012 <tt>conffile</tt>s, or, (if they do not exist in the .deb)
6013 by managing them correctly in the maintainer scripts (see
6014 <ref id="config-files">). This is important since we want
6015 to give the local system administrator the chance to adapt
6016 the scripts to the local system, e.g., to disable a
6017 service without de-installing the package, or to specify
6018 some special command line options when starting a service,
6019 while making sure their changes aren't lost during the next
6020 package upgrade.
6021 </p>
6024 These scripts should not fail obscurely when the
6025 configuration files remain but the package has been
6026 removed, as configuration files remain on the system after
6027 the package has been removed. Only when <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
6028 is executed with the <tt>--purge</tt> option will
6029 configuration files be removed. In particular, as the
6030 <file>/etc/init.d/<var>package</var></file> script itself is
6031 usually a <tt>conffile</tt>, it will remain on the system
6032 if the package is removed but not purged. Therefore, you
6033 should include a <tt>test</tt> statement at the top of the
6034 script, like this:
6035 <example compact="compact">
6036 test -f <var>program-executed-later-in-script</var> || exit 0
6037 </example>
6038 </p>
6041 Often there are some variables in the <file>init.d</file>
6042 scripts whose values control the behavior of the scripts,
6043 and which a system administrator is likely to want to
6044 change. As the scripts themselves are frequently
6045 <tt>conffile</tt>s, modifying them requires that the
6046 administrator merge in their changes each time the package
6047 is upgraded and the <tt>conffile</tt> changes. To ease
6048 the burden on the system administrator, such configurable
6049 values should not be placed directly in the script.
6050 Instead, they should be placed in a file in
6051 <file>/etc/default</file>, which typically will have the same
6052 base name as the <file>init.d</file> script. This extra file
6053 should be sourced by the script when the script runs. It
6054 must contain only variable settings and comments in SUSv3
6055 <prgn>sh</prgn> format. It may either be a
6056 <tt>conffile</tt> or a configuration file maintained by
6057 the package maintainer scripts. See <ref id="config-files">
6058 for more details.
6059 </p>
6062 To ensure that vital configurable values are always
6063 available, the <file>init.d</file> script should set default
6064 values for each of the shell variables it uses, either
6065 before sourcing the <file>/etc/default/</file> file or
6066 afterwards using something like the <tt>:
6067 ${VAR:=default}</tt> syntax. Also, the <file>init.d</file>
6068 script must behave sensibly and not fail if the
6069 <file>/etc/default</file> file is deleted.
6070 </p>
6073 <file>/var/run</file> and <file>/var/lock</file> may be mounted
6074 as temporary filesystems<footnote>
6075 For example, using the <tt>RAMRUN</tt> and <tt>RAMLOCK</tt>
6076 options in <file>/etc/default/rcS</file>.
6077 </footnote>, so the <file>init.d</file> scripts must handle this
6078 correctly. This will typically amount to creating any required
6079 subdirectories dynamically when the <file>init.d</file> script
6080 is run, rather than including them in the package and relying on
6081 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to create them.
6082 </p>
6083 </sect1>
6085 <sect1>
6086 <heading>Interfacing with the initscript system</heading>
6089 Maintainers should use the abstraction layer provided by
6090 the <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> and <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>
6091 programs to deal with initscripts in their packages'
6092 scripts such as <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn>
6093 and <prgn>postrm</prgn>.
6094 </p>
6097 Directly managing the /etc/rc?.d links and directly
6098 invoking the <file>/etc/init.d/</file> initscripts should
6099 be done only by packages providing the initscript
6100 subsystem (such as <prgn>sysv-rc</prgn> and
6101 <prgn>file-rc</prgn>).
6102 </p>
6104 <sect2>
6105 <heading>Managing the links</heading>
6108 The program <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> is provided for
6109 package maintainers to arrange for the proper creation and
6110 removal of <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> symbolic links,
6111 or their functional equivalent if another method is being
6112 used. This may be used by maintainers in their packages'
6113 <prgn>postinst</prgn> and <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts.
6114 </p>
6117 You must not include any <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file>
6118 symbolic links in the actual archive or manually create or
6119 remove the symbolic links in maintainer scripts; you must
6120 use the <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> program instead. (The
6121 former will fail if an alternative method of maintaining
6122 runlevel information is being used.) You must not include
6123 the <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directories themselves
6124 in the archive either. (Only the <tt>sysvinit</tt>
6125 package may do so.)
6126 </p>
6129 By default <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> will start services in
6130 each of the multi-user state runlevels (2, 3, 4, and 5)
6131 and stop them in the halt runlevel (0), the single-user
6132 runlevel (1) and the reboot runlevel (6). The system
6133 administrator will have the opportunity to customize
6134 runlevels by simply adding, moving, or removing the
6135 symbolic links in <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> if
6136 symbolic links are being used, or by modifying
6137 <file>/etc/runlevel.conf</file> if the <tt>file-rc</tt> method
6138 is being used.
6139 </p>
6142 To get the default behavior for your package, put in your
6143 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script
6144 <example compact="compact">
6145 update-rc.d <var>package</var> defaults
6146 </example>
6147 and in your <prgn>postrm</prgn>
6148 <example compact="compact">
6149 if [ "$1" = purge ]; then
6150 update-rc.d <var>package</var> remove
6152 </example>. Note that if your package changes runlevels
6153 or priority, you may have to remove and recreate the links,
6154 since otherwise the old links may persist. Refer to the
6155 documentation of <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn>.
6156 </p>
6159 This will use a default sequence number of 20. If it does
6160 not matter when or in which order the <file>init.d</file>
6161 script is run, use this default. If it does, then you
6162 should talk to the maintainer of the <prgn>sysvinit</prgn>
6163 package or post to <tt>debian-devel</tt>, and they will
6164 help you choose a number.
6165 </p>
6168 For more information about using <tt>update-rc.d</tt>,
6169 please consult its man page <manref name="update-rc.d"
6170 section="8">.
6171 </p>
6172 </sect2>
6174 <sect2>
6175 <heading>Running initscripts</heading>
6177 The program <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> is provided to make
6178 it easier for package maintainers to properly invoke an
6179 initscript, obeying runlevel and other locally-defined
6180 constraints that might limit a package's right to start,
6181 stop and otherwise manage services. This program may be
6182 used by maintainers in their packages' scripts.
6183 </p>
6186 The package maintainer scripts must use
6187 <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> to invoke the
6188 <file>/etc/init.d/*</file> initscripts, instead of
6189 calling them directly.
6190 </p>
6193 By default, <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> will pass any
6194 action requests (start, stop, reload, restart...) to the
6195 <file>/etc/init.d</file> script, filtering out requests
6196 to start or restart a service out of its intended
6197 runlevels.
6198 </p>
6201 Most packages will simply need to change:
6202 <example compact="compact">/etc/init.d/&lt;package&gt;
6203 &lt;action&gt;</example> in their <prgn>postinst</prgn>
6204 and <prgn>prerm</prgn> scripts to:
6205 <example compact="compact">
6206 if which invoke-rc.d >/dev/null 2>&1; then
6207 invoke-rc.d <var>package</var> &lt;action&gt;
6208 else
6209 /etc/init.d/<var>package</var> &lt;action&gt;
6211 </example>
6212 </p>
6215 A package should register its initscript services using
6216 <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> before it tries to invoke them
6217 using <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>. Invocation of
6218 unregistered services may fail.
6219 </p>
6222 For more information about using
6223 <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>, please consult its man page
6224 <manref name="invoke-rc.d" section="8">.
6225 </p>
6226 </sect2>
6227 </sect1>
6229 <sect1>
6230 <heading>Boot-time initialization</heading>
6233 There used to be another directory, <file>/etc/rc.boot</file>,
6234 which contained scripts which were run once per machine
6235 boot. This has been deprecated in favour of links from
6236 <file>/etc/rcS.d</file> to files in <file>/etc/init.d</file> as
6237 described in <ref id="/etc/init.d">. Packages must not
6238 place files in <file>/etc/rc.boot</file>.
6239 </p>
6240 </sect1>
6242 <sect1>
6243 <heading>Example</heading>
6246 An example on which you can base your
6247 <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts is found in
6248 <file>/etc/init.d/skeleton</file>.
6249 </p>
6251 </sect1>
6252 </sect>
6254 <sect>
6255 <heading>Console messages from <file>init.d</file> scripts</heading>
6258 This section describes the formats to be used for messages
6259 written to standard output by the <file>/etc/init.d</file>
6260 scripts. The intent is to improve the consistency of
6261 Debian's startup and shutdown look and feel. For this
6262 reason, please look very carefully at the details. We want
6263 the messages to have the same format in terms of wording,
6264 spaces, punctuation and case of letters.
6265 </p>
6268 Here is a list of overall rules that should be used for
6269 messages generated by <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts.
6270 </p>
6273 <list>
6274 <item>
6275 The message should fit in one line (fewer than 80
6276 characters), start with a capital letter and end with
6277 a period (<tt>.</tt>) and line feed (<tt>"\n"</tt>).
6278 </item>
6280 <item>
6281 If the script is performing some time consuming task in
6282 the background (not merely starting or stopping a
6283 program, for instance), an ellipsis (three dots:
6284 <tt>...</tt>) should be output to the screen, with no
6285 leading or tailing whitespace or line feeds.
6286 </item>
6288 <item>
6289 The messages should appear as if the computer is telling
6290 the user what it is doing (politely :-), but should not
6291 mention "it" directly. For example, instead of:
6292 <example compact="compact">
6293 I'm starting network daemons: nfsd mountd.
6294 </example>
6295 the message should say
6296 <example compact="compact">
6297 Starting network daemons: nfsd mountd.
6298 </example>
6299 </item>
6300 </list>
6301 </p>
6304 <tt>init.d</tt> script should use the following standard
6305 message formats for the situations enumerated below.
6306 </p>
6309 <list>
6310 <item>
6311 <p>When daemons are started</p>
6314 If the script starts one or more daemons, the output
6315 should look like this (a single line, no leading
6316 spaces):
6317 <example compact="compact">
6318 Starting <var>description</var>: <var>daemon-1</var> ... <var>daemon-n</var>.
6319 </example>
6320 The <var>description</var> should describe the
6321 subsystem the daemon or set of daemons are part of,
6322 while <var>daemon-1</var> up to <var>daemon-n</var>
6323 denote each daemon's name (typically the file name of
6324 the program).
6325 </p>
6328 For example, the output of <file>/etc/init.d/lpd</file>
6329 would look like:
6330 <example compact="compact">
6331 Starting printer spooler: lpd.
6332 </example>
6333 </p>
6336 This can be achieved by saying
6337 <example compact="compact">
6338 echo -n "Starting printer spooler: lpd"
6339 start-stop-daemon --start --quiet --exec /usr/sbin/lpd
6340 echo "."
6341 </example>
6342 in the script. If there are more than one daemon to
6343 start, the output should look like this:
6344 <example compact="compact">
6345 echo -n "Starting remote file system services:"
6346 echo -n " nfsd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet nfsd
6347 echo -n " mountd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet mountd
6348 echo -n " ugidd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet ugidd
6349 echo "."
6350 </example>
6351 This makes it possible for the user to see what is
6352 happening and when the final daemon has been started.
6353 Care should be taken in the placement of white spaces:
6354 in the example above the system administrators can
6355 easily comment out a line if they don't want to start
6356 a specific daemon, while the displayed message still
6357 looks good.
6358 </p>
6359 </item>
6361 <item>
6362 <p>When a system parameter is being set</p>
6365 If you have to set up different system parameters
6366 during the system boot, you should use this format:
6367 <example compact="compact">
6368 Setting <var>parameter</var> to "<var>value</var>".
6369 </example>
6370 </p>
6373 You can use a statement such as the following to get
6374 the quotes right:
6375 <example compact="compact">
6376 echo "Setting DNS domainname to \"$domainname\"."
6377 </example>
6378 </p>
6381 Note that the same symbol (<tt>"</tt>) is used for the left
6382 and right quotation marks. A grave accent (<tt>`</tt>) is
6383 not a quote character; neither is an apostrophe
6384 (<tt>'</tt>).
6385 </p>
6386 </item>
6388 <item>
6389 <p>When a daemon is stopped or restarted</p>
6392 When you stop or restart a daemon, you should issue a
6393 message identical to the startup message, except that
6394 <tt>Starting</tt> is replaced with <tt>Stopping</tt>
6395 or <tt>Restarting</tt> respectively.
6396 </p>
6399 For example, stopping the printer daemon will look like
6400 this:
6401 <example compact="compact">
6402 Stopping printer spooler: lpd.
6403 </example>
6404 </p>
6405 </item>
6407 <item>
6408 <p>When something is executed</p>
6411 There are several examples where you have to run a
6412 program at system startup or shutdown to perform a
6413 specific task, for example, setting the system's clock
6414 using <prgn>netdate</prgn> or killing all processes
6415 when the system shuts down. Your message should look
6416 like this:
6417 <example compact="compact">
6418 Doing something very useful...done.
6419 </example>
6420 You should print the <tt>done.</tt> immediately after
6421 the job has been completed, so that the user is
6422 informed why they have to wait. You can get this
6423 behavior by saying
6424 <example compact="compact">
6425 echo -n "Doing something very useful..."
6426 do_something
6427 echo "done."
6428 </example>
6429 in your script.
6430 </p>
6431 </item>
6433 <item>
6434 <p>When the configuration is reloaded</p>
6437 When a daemon is forced to reload its configuration
6438 files you should use the following format:
6439 <example compact="compact">
6440 Reloading <var>description</var> configuration...done.
6441 </example>
6442 where <var>description</var> is the same as in the
6443 daemon starting message.
6444 </p>
6445 </item>
6446 </list>
6447 </p>
6448 </sect>
6450 <sect>
6451 <heading>Cron jobs</heading>
6454 Packages must not modify the configuration file
6455 <file>/etc/crontab</file>, and they must not modify the files in
6456 <file>/var/spool/cron/crontabs</file>.</p>
6459 If a package wants to install a job that has to be executed
6460 via cron, it should place a file with the name of the
6461 package in one or more of the following directories:
6462 <example compact="compact">
6463 /etc/cron.hourly
6464 /etc/cron.daily
6465 /etc/cron.weekly
6466 /etc/cron.monthly
6467 </example>
6468 As these directory names imply, the files within them are
6469 executed on an hourly, daily, weekly, or monthly basis,
6470 respectively. The exact times are listed in
6471 <file>/etc/crontab</file>.</p>
6474 All files installed in any of these directories must be
6475 scripts (e.g., shell scripts or Perl scripts) so that they
6476 can easily be modified by the local system administrator.
6477 In addition, they must be treated as configuration files.
6478 </p>
6481 If a certain job has to be executed at some other frequency or
6482 at a specific time, the package should install a file
6483 <file>/etc/cron.d/<var>package</var></file>. This file uses the
6484 same syntax as <file>/etc/crontab</file> and is processed by
6485 <prgn>cron</prgn> automatically. The file must also be
6486 treated as a configuration file. (Note that entries in the
6487 <file>/etc/cron.d</file> directory are not handled by
6488 <prgn>anacron</prgn>. Thus, you should only use this
6489 directory for jobs which may be skipped if the system is not
6490 running.)</p>
6493 The scripts or crontab entries in these directories should
6494 check if all necessary programs are installed before they
6495 try to execute them. Otherwise, problems will arise when a
6496 package was removed but not purged since configuration files
6497 are kept on the system in this situation.</p>
6498 </sect>
6500 <sect id="menus">
6501 <heading>Menus</heading>
6504 The Debian <tt>menu</tt> package provides a standard
6505 interface between packages providing applications and
6506 <em>menu programs</em> (either X window managers or
6507 text-based menu programs such as <prgn>pdmenu</prgn>).
6508 </p>
6511 All packages that provide applications that need not be
6512 passed any special command line arguments for normal
6513 operation should register a menu entry for those
6514 applications, so that users of the <tt>menu</tt> package
6515 will automatically get menu entries in their window
6516 managers, as well in shells like <tt>pdmenu</tt>.
6517 </p>
6520 Menu entries should follow the current menu policy.
6521 </p>
6524 The menu policy can be found in the <tt>menu-policy</tt>
6525 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
6526 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
6527 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/menu-policy/"
6528 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/menu-policy/"></tt>.
6529 </p>
6532 Please also refer to the <em>Debian Menu System</em>
6533 documentation that comes with the <package>menu</package>
6534 package for information about how to register your
6535 applications.
6536 </p>
6537 </sect>
6539 <sect id="mime">
6540 <heading>Multimedia handlers</heading>
6543 MIME (Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions, RFCs 2045-2049)
6544 is a mechanism for encoding files and data streams and
6545 providing meta-information about them, in particular their
6546 type (e.g. audio or video) and format (e.g. PNG, HTML,
6547 MP3).
6548 </p>
6551 Registration of MIME type handlers allows programs like mail
6552 user agents and web browsers to invoke these handlers to
6553 view, edit or display MIME types they don't support directly.
6554 </p>
6557 Packages which provide the ability to view/show/play,
6558 compose, edit or print MIME types should register themselves
6559 as such following the current MIME support policy.
6560 </p>
6563 The MIME support policy can be found in the <tt>mime-policy</tt>
6564 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
6565 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
6566 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/mime-policy/"
6567 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/mime-policy/"></tt>.
6568 </p>
6570 </sect>
6572 <sect>
6573 <heading>Keyboard configuration</heading>
6576 To achieve a consistent keyboard configuration so that all
6577 applications interpret a keyboard event the same way, all
6578 programs in the Debian distribution must be configured to
6579 comply with the following guidelines.
6580 </p>
6583 The following keys must have the specified interpretations:
6585 <taglist>
6586 <tag><tt>&lt;--</tt></tag>
6587 <item>delete the character to the left of the cursor</item>
6589 <tag><tt>Delete</tt></tag>
6590 <item>delete the character to the right of the cursor</item>
6592 <tag><tt>Control+H</tt></tag>
6593 <item>emacs: the help prefix</item>
6594 </taglist>
6596 The interpretation of any keyboard events should be
6597 independent of the terminal that is used, be it a virtual
6598 console, an X terminal emulator, an rlogin/telnet session,
6599 etc.
6600 </p>
6603 The following list explains how the different programs
6604 should be set up to achieve this:
6605 </p>
6608 <list>
6609 <item>
6610 <tt>&lt;--</tt> generates <tt>KB_BackSpace</tt> in X.
6611 </item>
6613 <item>
6614 <tt>Delete</tt> generates <tt>KB_Delete</tt> in X.
6615 </item>
6617 <item>
6618 X translations are set up to make
6619 <tt>KB_Backspace</tt> generate ASCII DEL, and to make
6620 <tt>KB_Delete</tt> generate <tt>ESC [ 3 ~</tt> (this
6621 is the vt220 escape code for the "delete character"
6622 key). This must be done by loading the X resources
6623 using <prgn>xrdb</prgn> on all local X displays, not
6624 using the application defaults, so that the
6625 translation resources used correspond to the
6626 <prgn>xmodmap</prgn> settings.
6627 </item>
6629 <item>
6630 The Linux console is configured to make
6631 <tt>&lt;--</tt> generate DEL, and <tt>Delete</tt>
6632 generate <tt>ESC [ 3 ~</tt>.
6633 </item>
6635 <item>
6636 X applications are configured so that <tt>&lt;</tt>
6637 deletes left, and <tt>Delete</tt> deletes right. Motif
6638 applications already work like this.
6639 </item>
6641 <item>
6642 Terminals should have <tt>stty erase ^?</tt> .
6643 </item>
6645 <item>
6646 The <tt>xterm</tt> terminfo entry should have <tt>ESC
6647 [ 3 ~</tt> for <tt>kdch1</tt>, just as for
6648 <tt>TERM=linux</tt> and <tt>TERM=vt220</tt>.
6649 </item>
6651 <item>
6652 Emacs is programmed to map <tt>KB_Backspace</tt> or
6653 the <tt>stty erase</tt> character to
6654 <tt>delete-backward-char</tt>, and <tt>KB_Delete</tt>
6655 or <tt>kdch1</tt> to <tt>delete-forward-char</tt>, and
6656 <tt>^H</tt> to <tt>help</tt> as always.
6657 </item>
6659 <item>
6660 Other applications use the <tt>stty erase</tt>
6661 character and <tt>kdch1</tt> for the two delete keys,
6662 with ASCII DEL being "delete previous character" and
6663 <tt>kdch1</tt> being "delete character under
6664 cursor".
6665 </item>
6667 </list>
6668 </p>
6671 This will solve the problem except for the following
6672 cases:
6673 </p>
6676 <list>
6677 <item>
6678 Some terminals have a <tt>&lt;--</tt> key that cannot
6679 be made to produce anything except <tt>^H</tt>. On
6680 these terminals Emacs help will be unavailable on
6681 <tt>^H</tt> (assuming that the <tt>stty erase</tt>
6682 character takes precedence in Emacs, and has been set
6683 correctly). <tt>M-x help</tt> or <tt>F1</tt> (if
6684 available) can be used instead.
6685 </item>
6687 <item>
6688 Some operating systems use <tt>^H</tt> for <tt>stty
6689 erase</tt>. However, modern telnet versions and all
6690 rlogin versions propagate <tt>stty</tt> settings, and
6691 almost all UNIX versions honour <tt>stty erase</tt>.
6692 Where the <tt>stty</tt> settings are not propagated
6693 correctly, things can be made to work by using
6694 <tt>stty</tt> manually.
6695 </item>
6697 <item>
6698 Some systems (including previous Debian versions) use
6699 <prgn>xmodmap</prgn> to arrange for both
6700 <tt>&lt;--</tt> and <tt>Delete</tt> to generate
6701 <tt>KB_Delete</tt>. We can change the behavior of
6702 their X clients using the same X resources that we use
6703 to do it for our own clients, or configure our clients
6704 using their resources when things are the other way
6705 around. On displays configured like this
6706 <tt>Delete</tt> will not work, but <tt>&lt;--</tt>
6707 will.
6708 </item>
6710 <item>
6711 Some operating systems have different <tt>kdch1</tt>
6712 settings in their <tt>terminfo</tt> database for
6713 <tt>xterm</tt> and others. On these systems the
6714 <tt>Delete</tt> key will not work correctly when you
6715 log in from a system conforming to our policy, but
6716 <tt>&lt;--</tt> will.
6717 </item>
6718 </list>
6719 </p>
6720 </sect>
6722 <sect>
6723 <heading>Environment variables</heading>
6726 A program must not depend on environment variables to get
6727 reasonable defaults. (That's because these environment
6728 variables would have to be set in a system-wide
6729 configuration file like <file>/etc/profile</file>, which is not
6730 supported by all shells.)
6731 </p>
6734 If a program usually depends on environment variables for its
6735 configuration, the program should be changed to fall back to
6736 a reasonable default configuration if these environment
6737 variables are not present. If this cannot be done easily
6738 (e.g., if the source code of a non-free program is not
6739 available), the program must be replaced by a small
6740 "wrapper" shell script which sets the environment variables
6741 if they are not already defined, and calls the original program.
6742 </p>
6745 Here is an example of a wrapper script for this purpose:
6747 <example compact="compact">
6748 #!/bin/sh
6749 BAR=${BAR:-/var/lib/fubar}
6750 export BAR
6751 exec /usr/lib/foo/foo "$@"
6752 </example>
6753 </p>
6756 Furthermore, as <file>/etc/profile</file> is a configuration
6757 file of the <prgn>base-files</prgn> package, other packages must
6758 not put any environment variables or other commands into that
6759 file.
6760 </p>
6761 </sect>
6763 <sect id="doc-base">
6764 <heading>Registering Documents using doc-base</heading>
6767 The <package>doc-base</package> package implements a
6768 flexible mechanism for handling and presenting
6769 documentation. The recommended practice is for every Debian
6770 package that provides online documentation (other than just
6771 manual pages) to register these documents with
6772 <package>doc-base</package> by installing a
6773 <package>doc-base</package> control file via the
6774 <prgn/install-docs/ script at installation time and
6775 de-register the manuals again when the package is removed.
6776 </p>
6778 Please refer to the documentation that comes with the
6779 <package>doc-base</package> package for information and
6780 details.
6781 </p>
6782 </sect>
6784 </chapt>
6787 <chapt id="files">
6788 <heading>Files</heading>
6790 <sect>
6791 <heading>Binaries</heading>
6794 Two different packages must not install programs with
6795 different functionality but with the same filenames. (The
6796 case of two programs having the same functionality but
6797 different implementations is handled via "alternatives" or
6798 the "Conflicts" mechanism. See <ref id="maintscripts"> and
6799 <ref id="conflicts"> respectively.) If this case happens,
6800 one of the programs must be renamed. The maintainers should
6801 report this to the <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list and
6802 try to find a consensus about which program will have to be
6803 renamed. If a consensus cannot be reached, <em>both</em>
6804 programs must be renamed.
6805 </p>
6808 By default, when a package is being built, any binaries
6809 created should include debugging information, as well as
6810 being compiled with optimization. You should also turn on
6811 as many reasonable compilation warnings as possible; this
6812 makes life easier for porters, who can then look at build
6813 logs for possible problems. For the C programming language,
6814 this means the following compilation parameters should be
6815 used:
6816 <example compact="compact">
6817 CC = gcc
6818 CFLAGS = -O2 -g -Wall # sane warning options vary between programs
6819 LDFLAGS = # none
6820 INSTALL = install -s # (or use strip on the files in debian/tmp)
6821 </example>
6822 </p>
6825 Note that by default all installed binaries should be stripped,
6826 either by using the <tt>-s</tt> flag to
6827 <prgn>install</prgn>, or by calling <prgn>strip</prgn> on
6828 the binaries after they have been copied into
6829 <file>debian/tmp</file> but before the tree is made into a
6830 package.
6831 </p>
6834 Although binaries in the build tree should be compiled with
6835 debugging information by default, it can often be difficult to
6836 debug programs if they are also subjected to compiler
6837 optimization. For this reason, it is recommended to support the
6838 standardized environment variable <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt>
6839 (see <ref id="debianrules-options">). This variable can contain
6840 several flags to change how a package is compiled and built.
6841 </p>
6844 It is up to the package maintainer to decide what
6845 compilation options are best for the package. Certain
6846 binaries (such as computationally-intensive programs) will
6847 function better with certain flags (<tt>-O3</tt>, for
6848 example); feel free to use them. Please use good judgment
6849 here. Don't use flags for the sake of it; only use them
6850 if there is good reason to do so. Feel free to override
6851 the upstream author's ideas about which compilation
6852 options are best: they are often inappropriate for our
6853 environment.
6854 </p>
6855 </sect>
6858 <sect id="libraries">
6859 <heading>Libraries</heading>
6862 If the package is <strong>architecture: any</strong>, then
6863 the shared library compilation and linking flags must have
6864 <tt>-fPIC</tt>, or the package shall not build on some of
6865 the supported architectures<footnote>
6867 If you are using GCC, <tt>-fPIC</tt> produces code with
6868 relocatable position independent code, which is required for
6869 most architectures to create a shared library, with i386 and
6870 perhaps some others where non position independent code is
6871 permitted in a shared library.
6872 </p>
6874 Position independent code may have a performance penalty,
6875 especially on <tt>i386</tt>. However, in most cases the
6876 speed penalty must be measured against the memory wasted on
6877 the few architectures where non position independent code is
6878 even possible.
6879 </p>
6880 </footnote>. Any exception to this rule must be discussed on
6881 the mailing list <em>debian-devel@lists.debian.org</em>, and
6882 a rough consensus obtained. The reasons for not compiling
6883 with <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag must be recorded in the file
6884 <tt>README.Debian</tt>, and care must be taken to either
6885 restrict the architecture or arrange for <tt>-fPIC</tt> to
6886 be used on architectures where it is required.<footnote>
6888 Some of the reasons why this might be required is if the
6889 library contains hand crafted assembly code that is not
6890 relocatable, the speed penalty is excessive for compute
6891 intensive libs, and similar reasons.
6892 </p>
6893 </footnote>
6894 </p>
6896 As to the static libraries, the common case is not to have
6897 relocatable code, since there is no benefit, unless in specific
6898 cases; therefore the static version must not be compiled
6899 with the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag. Any exception to this rule
6900 should be discussed on the mailing list
6901 <em>debian-devel@lists.debian.org</em>, and the reasons for
6902 compiling with the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag must be recorded in
6903 the file <tt>README.Debian</tt>. <footnote>
6905 Some of the reasons for linking static libraries with
6906 the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag are if, for example, one needs a
6907 Perl API for a library that is under rapid development,
6908 and has an unstable API, so shared libraries are
6909 pointless at this phase of the library's development. In
6910 that case, since Perl needs a library with relocatable
6911 code, it may make sense to create a static library with
6912 relocatable code. Another reason cited is if you are
6913 distilling various libraries into a common shared
6914 library, like <tt>mklibs</tt> does in the Debian
6915 installer project.
6916 </p>
6917 </footnote>
6918 </p>
6920 In other words, if both a shared and a static library is
6921 being built, each source unit (<tt>*.c</tt>, for example,
6922 for C files) will need to be compiled twice, for the normal
6923 case.
6924 </p>
6926 You must specify the gcc option <tt>-D_REENTRANT</tt>
6927 when building a library (either static or shared) to make
6928 the library compatible with LinuxThreads.
6929 </p>
6932 Although not enforced by the build tools, shared libraries
6933 must be linked against all libraries that they use symbols from
6934 in the same way that binaries are. This ensures the correct
6935 functioning of the <qref id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps">shlibs</qref>
6936 system and guarantees that all libraries can be safely opened
6937 with <tt>dlopen()</tt>. Packagers may wish to use the gcc
6938 option <tt>-Wl,-z,defs</tt> when building a shared library.
6939 Since this option enforces symbol resolution at build time,
6940 a missing library reference will be caught early as a fatal
6941 build error.
6942 </p>
6945 All installed shared libraries should be stripped with
6946 <example compact="compact">
6947 strip --strip-unneeded <var>your-lib</var>
6948 </example>
6949 (The option <tt>--strip-unneeded</tt> makes
6950 <prgn>strip</prgn> remove only the symbols which aren't
6951 needed for relocation processing.) Shared libraries can
6952 function perfectly well when stripped, since the symbols for
6953 dynamic linking are in a separate part of the ELF object
6954 file.<footnote>
6955 You might also want to use the options
6956 <tt>--remove-section=.comment</tt> and
6957 <tt>--remove-section=.note</tt> on both shared libraries
6958 and executables, and <tt>--strip-debug</tt> on static
6959 libraries.
6960 </footnote>
6961 </p>
6964 Note that under some circumstances it may be useful to
6965 install a shared library unstripped, for example when
6966 building a separate package to support debugging.
6967 </p>
6970 Shared object files (often <file>.so</file> files) that are not
6971 public libraries, that is, they are not meant to be linked
6972 to by third party executables (binaries of other packages),
6973 should be installed in subdirectories of the
6974 <file>/usr/lib</file> directory. Such files are exempt from the
6975 rules that govern ordinary shared libraries, except that
6976 they must not be installed executable and should be
6977 stripped.<footnote>
6978 A common example are the so-called "plug-ins",
6979 internal shared objects that are dynamically loaded by
6980 programs using <manref name="dlopen" section="3">.
6981 </footnote>
6982 </p>
6985 Packages containing shared libraries that may be linked to
6986 by other packages' binaries, but which for some
6987 <em>compelling</em> reason can not be installed in
6988 <file>/usr/lib</file> directory, may install the shared library
6989 files in subdirectories of the <file>/usr/lib</file> directory,
6990 in which case they should arrange to add that directory in
6991 <file>/etc/ld.so.conf</file> in the package's post-installation
6992 script, and remove it in the package's post-removal script.
6993 </p>
6996 An ever increasing number of packages are using
6997 <prgn>libtool</prgn> to do their linking. The latest GNU
6998 libtools (>= 1.3a) can take advantage of the metadata in the
6999 installed <prgn>libtool</prgn> archive files (<file>*.la</file>
7000 files). The main advantage of <prgn>libtool</prgn>'s
7001 <file>.la</file> files is that it allows <prgn>libtool</prgn> to
7002 store and subsequently access metadata with respect to the
7003 libraries it builds. <prgn>libtool</prgn> will search for
7004 those files, which contain a lot of useful information about
7005 a library (such as library dependency information for static
7006 linking). Also, they're <em>essential</em> for programs
7007 using <tt>libltdl</tt>.<footnote>
7008 Although <prgn>libtool</prgn> is fully capable of
7009 linking against shared libraries which don't have
7010 <tt>.la</tt> files, as it is a mere shell script it can
7011 add considerably to the build time of a
7012 <prgn>libtool</prgn>-using package if that shell script
7013 has to derive all this information from first principles
7014 for each library every time it is linked. With the
7015 advent of <prgn>libtool</prgn> version 1.4 (and to a
7016 lesser extent <prgn>libtool</prgn> version 1.3), the
7017 <file>.la</file> files also store information about
7018 inter-library dependencies which cannot necessarily be
7019 derived after the <file>.la</file> file is deleted.
7020 </footnote>
7021 </p>
7024 Packages that use <prgn>libtool</prgn> to create shared
7025 libraries should include the <file>.la</file> files in the
7026 <tt>-dev</tt> package, unless the package relies on
7027 <tt>libtool</tt>'s <tt>libltdl</tt> library, in which case
7028 the <tt>.la</tt> files must go in the run-time library
7029 package.
7030 </p>
7033 You must make sure that you use only released versions of
7034 shared libraries to build your packages; otherwise other
7035 users will not be able to run your binaries
7036 properly. Producing source packages that depend on
7037 unreleased compilers is also usually a bad
7038 idea.
7039 </p>
7040 </sect>
7043 <sect>
7044 <heading>Shared libraries</heading>
7046 This section has moved to <ref id="sharedlibs">.
7047 </p>
7048 </sect>
7051 <sect id="scripts">
7052 <heading>Scripts</heading>
7055 All command scripts, including the package maintainer
7056 scripts inside the package and used by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>,
7057 should have a <tt>#!</tt> line naming the shell to be used
7058 to interpret them.
7059 </p>
7062 In the case of Perl scripts this should be
7063 <tt>#!/usr/bin/perl</tt>.
7064 </p>
7067 When scripts are installed into a directory in the system
7068 PATH, the script name should not include an extension such
7069 as <tt>.sh</tt> or <tt>.pl</tt> that denotes the scripting
7070 language currently used to implement it.
7071 </p>
7073 Shell scripts (<prgn>sh</prgn> and <prgn>bash</prgn>)
7074 should almost certainly start with <tt>set -e</tt> so that
7075 errors are detected. Every script should use
7076 <tt>set -e</tt> or check the exit status of <em>every</em>
7077 command.
7078 </p>
7081 Scripts may assume that <file>/bin/sh</file> implements the
7082 SUSv3 Shell Command Language<footnote>
7083 Single UNIX Specification, version 3, which is also IEEE
7084 1003.1-2004 (POSIX), and is available on the World Wide Web
7085 from <url id="http://www.unix.org/version3/online.html"
7086 name="The Open Group"> after free
7087 registration.</footnote>
7088 plus the following additional features not mandated by
7089 SUSv3:<footnote>
7090 These features are in widespread use in the Linux community
7091 and are implemented in all of bash, dash, and ksh, the most
7092 common shells users may wish to use as <file>/bin/sh</file>.
7093 </footnote>
7094 <list>
7095 <item><tt>echo -n</tt>, if implemented as a shell built-in,
7096 must not generate a newline.</item>
7097 <item><tt>test</tt>, if implemented as a shell built-in, must
7098 support <tt>-a</tt> and <tt>-o</tt> as binary logical
7099 operators.</item>
7100 <item><tt>local</tt> to create a scoped variable must be
7101 supported, including listing multiple variables in a single
7102 local command and assigning a value to a variable at the
7103 same time as localizing it. <tt>local</tt> may or
7104 may not preserve the variable value from an outer scope if
7105 no assignment is present. Uses such as:
7106 <example compact>
7107 fname () {
7108 local a b c=delta d
7109 # ... use a, b, c, d ...
7111 </example>
7112 must be supported and must set the value of <tt>c</tt> to
7113 <tt>delta</tt>.
7114 </item>
7115 </list>
7116 If a shell script requires non-SUSv3 features from the shell
7117 interpreter other than those listed above, the appropriate shell
7118 must be specified in the first line of the script (e.g.,
7119 <tt>#!/bin/bash</tt>) and the package must depend on the package
7120 providing the shell (unless the shell package is marked
7121 "Essential", as in the case of <prgn>bash</prgn>).
7122 </p>
7125 You may wish to restrict your script to SUSv3 features plus the
7126 above set when possible so that it may use <file>/bin/sh</file>
7127 as its interpreter. If your script works with <prgn>dash</prgn>
7128 (originally called <prgn>ash</prgn>), it probably complies with
7129 the above requirements, but if you are in doubt, use
7130 <file>/bin/bash</file>.
7131 </p>
7134 Perl scripts should check for errors when making any
7135 system calls, including <tt>open</tt>, <tt>print</tt>,
7136 <tt>close</tt>, <tt>rename</tt> and <tt>system</tt>.
7137 </p>
7140 <prgn>csh</prgn> and <prgn>tcsh</prgn> should be avoided as
7141 scripting languages. See <em>Csh Programming Considered
7142 Harmful</em>, one of the <tt>comp.unix.*</tt> FAQs, which
7143 can be found at <url id="http://www.faqs.org/faqs/unix-faq/shell/csh-whynot/">.
7144 If an upstream package comes with <prgn>csh</prgn> scripts
7145 then you must make sure that they start with
7146 <tt>#!/bin/csh</tt> and make your package depend on the
7147 <prgn>c-shell</prgn> virtual package.
7148 </p>
7151 Any scripts which create files in world-writeable
7152 directories (e.g., in <file>/tmp</file>) must use a
7153 mechanism which will fail atomically if a file with the same
7154 name already exists.
7155 </p>
7158 The Debian base system provides the <prgn>tempfile</prgn>
7159 and <prgn>mktemp</prgn> utilities for use by scripts for
7160 this purpose.
7161 </p>
7162 </sect>
7165 <sect>
7166 <heading>Symbolic links</heading>
7169 In general, symbolic links within a top-level directory
7170 should be relative, and symbolic links pointing from one
7171 top-level directory into another should be absolute. (A
7172 top-level directory is a sub-directory of the root
7173 directory <file>/</file>.)
7174 </p>
7177 In addition, symbolic links should be specified as short as
7178 possible, i.e., link targets like <file>foo/../bar</file> are
7179 deprecated.
7180 </p>
7183 Note that when creating a relative link using
7184 <prgn>ln</prgn> it is not necessary for the target of the
7185 link to exist relative to the working directory you're
7186 running <prgn>ln</prgn> from, nor is it necessary to change
7187 directory to the directory where the link is to be made.
7188 Simply include the string that should appear as the target
7189 of the link (this will be a pathname relative to the
7190 directory in which the link resides) as the first argument
7191 to <prgn>ln</prgn>.
7192 </p>
7195 For example, in your <prgn>Makefile</prgn> or
7196 <file>debian/rules</file>, you can do things like:
7197 <example compact="compact">
7198 ln -fs gcc $(prefix)/bin/cc
7199 ln -fs gcc debian/tmp/usr/bin/cc
7200 ln -fs ../sbin/sendmail $(prefix)/bin/runq
7201 ln -fs ../sbin/sendmail debian/tmp/usr/bin/runq
7202 </example>
7203 </p>
7206 A symbolic link pointing to a compressed file should always
7207 have the same file extension as the referenced file. (For
7208 example, if a file <file>foo.gz</file> is referenced by a
7209 symbolic link, the filename of the link has to end with
7210 "<file>.gz</file>" too, as in <file>bar.gz</file>.)
7211 </p>
7212 </sect>
7214 <sect>
7215 <heading>Device files</heading>
7218 Packages must not include device files in the package file
7219 tree.
7220 </p>
7223 If a package needs any special device files that are not
7224 included in the base system, it must call
7225 <prgn>MAKEDEV</prgn> in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script,
7226 after notifying the user<footnote>
7227 This notification could be done via a (low-priority)
7228 debconf message, or an echo (printf) statement.
7229 </footnote>.
7230 </p>
7233 Packages must not remove any device files in the
7234 <prgn>postrm</prgn> or any other script. This is left to the
7235 system administrator.
7236 </p>
7239 Debian uses the serial devices
7240 <file>/dev/ttyS*</file>. Programs using the old
7241 <file>/dev/cu*</file> devices should be changed to use
7242 <file>/dev/ttyS*</file>.
7243 </p>
7244 </sect>
7246 <sect id="config-files">
7247 <heading>Configuration files</heading>
7249 <sect1>
7250 <heading>Definitions</heading>
7253 <taglist>
7254 <tag>configuration file</tag>
7255 <item>
7256 A file that affects the operation of a program, or
7257 provides site- or host-specific information, or
7258 otherwise customizes the behavior of a program.
7259 Typically, configuration files are intended to be
7260 modified by the system administrator (if needed or
7261 desired) to conform to local policy or to provide
7262 more useful site-specific behavior.
7263 </item>
7265 <tag><tt>conffile</tt></tag>
7266 <item>
7267 A file listed in a package's <tt>conffiles</tt>
7268 file, and is treated specially by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
7269 (see <ref id="configdetails">).
7270 </item>
7271 </taglist>
7272 </p>
7275 The distinction between these two is important; they are
7276 not interchangeable concepts. Almost all
7277 <tt>conffile</tt>s are configuration files, but many
7278 configuration files are not <tt>conffiles</tt>.
7279 </p>
7282 As noted elsewhere, <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts,
7283 <file>/etc/default</file> files, scripts installed in
7284 <file>/etc/cron.{hourly,daily,weekly,monthly}</file>, and cron
7285 configuration installed in <file>/etc/cron.d</file> must be
7286 treated as configuration files. In general, any script that
7287 embeds configuration information is de-facto a configuration
7288 file and should be treated as such.
7289 </p>
7290 </sect1>
7292 <sect1>
7293 <heading>Location</heading>
7296 Any configuration files created or used by your package
7297 must reside in <file>/etc</file>. If there are several,
7298 consider creating a subdirectory of <file>/etc</file>
7299 named after your package.
7300 </p>
7303 If your package creates or uses configuration files
7304 outside of <file>/etc</file>, and it is not feasible to modify
7305 the package to use <file>/etc</file> directly, put the files
7306 in <file>/etc</file> and create symbolic links to those files
7307 from the location that the package requires.
7308 </p>
7309 </sect1>
7311 <sect1>
7312 <heading>Behavior</heading>
7315 Configuration file handling must conform to the following
7316 behavior:
7317 <list compact="compact">
7318 <item>
7319 local changes must be preserved during a package
7320 upgrade, and
7321 </item>
7322 <item>
7323 configuration files must be preserved when the
7324 package is removed, and only deleted when the
7325 package is purged.
7326 </item>
7327 </list>
7328 </p>
7331 The easy way to achieve this behavior is to make the
7332 configuration file a <tt>conffile</tt>. This is
7333 appropriate only if it is possible to distribute a default
7334 version that will work for most installations, although
7335 some system administrators may choose to modify it. This
7336 implies that the default version will be part of the
7337 package distribution, and must not be modified by the
7338 maintainer scripts during installation (or at any other
7339 time).
7340 </p>
7343 In order to ensure that local changes are preserved
7344 correctly, no package may contain or make hard links to
7345 conffiles.<footnote>
7346 Rationale: There are two problems with hard links.
7347 The first is that some editors break the link while
7348 editing one of the files, so that the two files may
7349 unwittingly become unlinked and different. The second
7350 is that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> might break the hard link
7351 while upgrading <tt>conffile</tt>s.
7352 </footnote>
7353 </p>
7356 The other way to do it is via the maintainer scripts. In
7357 this case, the configuration file must not be listed as a
7358 <tt>conffile</tt> and must not be part of the package
7359 distribution. If the existence of a file is required for
7360 the package to be sensibly configured it is the
7361 responsibility of the package maintainer to provide
7362 maintainer scripts which correctly create, update and
7363 maintain the file and remove it on purge. (See <ref
7364 id="maintainerscripts"> for more information.) These
7365 scripts must be idempotent (i.e., must work correctly if
7366 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> needs to re-run them due to errors
7367 during installation or removal), must cope with all the
7368 variety of ways <prgn>dpkg</prgn> can call maintainer
7369 scripts, must not overwrite or otherwise mangle the user's
7370 configuration without asking, must not ask unnecessary
7371 questions (particularly during upgrades), and must
7372 otherwise be good citizens.
7373 </p>
7376 The scripts are not required to configure every possible
7377 option for the package, but only those necessary to get
7378 the package running on a given system. Ideally the
7379 sysadmin should not have to do any configuration other
7380 than that done (semi-)automatically by the
7381 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script.
7382 </p>
7385 A common practice is to create a script called
7386 <file><var>package</var>-configure</file> and have the
7387 package's <prgn>postinst</prgn> call it if and only if the
7388 configuration file does not already exist. In certain
7389 cases it is useful for there to be an example or template
7390 file which the maintainer scripts use. Such files should
7391 be in <file>/usr/share/<var>package</var></file> or
7392 <file>/usr/lib/<var>package</var></file> (depending on whether
7393 they are architecture-independent or not). There should
7394 be symbolic links to them from
7395 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file> if
7396 they are examples, and should be perfectly ordinary
7397 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>-handled files (<em>not</em>
7398 configuration files).
7399 </p>
7402 These two styles of configuration file handling must
7403 not be mixed, for that way lies madness:
7404 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will ask about overwriting the file
7405 every time the package is upgraded.
7406 </p>
7407 </sect1>
7409 <sect1>
7410 <heading>Sharing configuration files</heading>
7413 Packages which specify the same file as a
7414 <tt>conffile</tt> must be tagged as <em>conflicting</em>
7415 with each other. (This is an instance of the general rule
7416 about not sharing files. Note that neither alternatives
7417 nor diversions are likely to be appropriate in this case;
7418 in particular, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> does not handle diverted
7419 <tt>conffile</tt>s well.)
7420 </p>
7423 The maintainer scripts must not alter a <tt>conffile</tt>
7424 of <em>any</em> package, including the one the scripts
7425 belong to.
7426 </p>
7429 If two or more packages use the same configuration file
7430 and it is reasonable for both to be installed at the same
7431 time, one of these packages must be defined as
7432 <em>owner</em> of the configuration file, i.e., it will be
7433 the package which handles that file as a configuration
7434 file. Other packages that use the configuration file must
7435 depend on the owning package if they require the
7436 configuration file to operate. If the other package will
7437 use the configuration file if present, but is capable of
7438 operating without it, no dependency need be declared.
7439 </p>
7442 If it is desirable for two or more related packages to
7443 share a configuration file <em>and</em> for all of the
7444 related packages to be able to modify that configuration
7445 file, then the following should be done:
7446 <enumlist compact="compact">
7447 <item>
7448 One of the related packages (the "owning" package)
7449 will manage the configuration file with maintainer
7450 scripts as described in the previous section.
7451 </item>
7452 <item>
7453 The owning package should also provide a program
7454 that the other packages may use to modify the
7455 configuration file.
7456 </item>
7457 <item>
7458 The related packages must use the provided program
7459 to make any desired modifications to the
7460 configuration file. They should either depend on
7461 the core package to guarantee that the configuration
7462 modifier program is available or accept gracefully
7463 that they cannot modify the configuration file if it
7464 is not. (This is in addition to the fact that the
7465 configuration file may not even be present in the
7466 latter scenario.)
7467 </item>
7468 </enumlist>
7469 </p>
7472 Sometimes it's appropriate to create a new package which
7473 provides the basic infrastructure for the other packages
7474 and which manages the shared configuration files. (The
7475 <tt>sgml-base</tt> package is a good example.)
7476 </p>
7477 </sect1>
7479 <sect1>
7480 <heading>User configuration files ("dotfiles")</heading>
7483 The files in <file>/etc/skel</file> will automatically be
7484 copied into new user accounts by <prgn>adduser</prgn>.
7485 No other program should reference the files in
7486 <file>/etc/skel</file>.
7487 </p>
7490 Therefore, if a program needs a dotfile to exist in
7491 advance in <file>$HOME</file> to work sensibly, that dotfile
7492 should be installed in <file>/etc/skel</file> and treated as a
7493 configuration file.
7494 </p>
7497 However, programs that require dotfiles in order to
7498 operate sensibly are a bad thing, unless they do create
7499 the dotfiles themselves automatically.
7500 </p>
7503 Furthermore, programs should be configured by the Debian
7504 default installation to behave as closely to the upstream
7505 default behavior as possible.
7506 </p>
7509 Therefore, if a program in a Debian package needs to be
7510 configured in some way in order to operate sensibly, that
7511 should be done using a site-wide configuration file placed
7512 in <file>/etc</file>. Only if the program doesn't support a
7513 site-wide default configuration and the package maintainer
7514 doesn't have time to add it may a default per-user file be
7515 placed in <file>/etc/skel</file>.
7516 </p>
7519 <file>/etc/skel</file> should be as empty as we can make it.
7520 This is particularly true because there is no easy (or
7521 necessarily desirable) mechanism for ensuring that the
7522 appropriate dotfiles are copied into the accounts of
7523 existing users when a package is installed.
7524 </p>
7525 </sect1>
7526 </sect>
7528 <sect>
7529 <heading>Log files</heading>
7531 Log files should usually be named
7532 <file>/var/log/<var>package</var>.log</file>. If you have many
7533 log files, or need a separate directory for permission
7534 reasons (<file>/var/log</file> is writable only by
7535 <file>root</file>), you should usually create a directory named
7536 <file>/var/log/<var>package</var></file> and place your log
7537 files there.
7538 </p>
7541 Log files must be rotated occasionally so that they don't
7542 grow indefinitely; the best way to do this is to drop a log
7543 rotation configuration file into the directory
7544 <file>/etc/logrotate.d</file> and use the facilities provided by
7545 logrotate.<footnote>
7547 The traditional approach to log files has been to set up
7548 <em>ad hoc</em> log rotation schemes using simple shell
7549 scripts and cron. While this approach is highly
7550 customizable, it requires quite a lot of sysadmin work.
7551 Even though the original Debian system helped a little
7552 by automatically installing a system which can be used
7553 as a template, this was deemed not enough.
7554 </p>
7557 The use of <prgn>logrotate</prgn>, a program developed
7558 by Red Hat, is better, as it centralizes log management.
7559 It has both a configuration file
7560 (<file>/etc/logrotate.conf</file>) and a directory where
7561 packages can drop their individual log rotation
7562 configurations (<file>/etc/logrotate.d</file>).
7563 </p>
7564 </footnote>
7565 Here is a good example for a logrotate config
7566 file (for more information see <manref name="logrotate"
7567 section="8">):
7568 <example compact="compact">
7569 /var/log/foo/*.log {
7570 rotate 12
7571 weekly
7572 compress
7573 postrotate
7574 /etc/init.d/foo force-reload
7575 endscript
7577 </example>
7578 This rotates all files under <file>/var/log/foo</file>, saves 12
7579 compressed generations, and forces the daemon to reload its
7580 configuration information after the log rotation.
7581 </p>
7584 Log files should be removed when the package is
7585 purged (but not when it is only removed). This should be
7586 done by the <prgn>postrm</prgn> script when it is called
7587 with the argument <tt>purge</tt> (see <ref
7588 id="removedetails">).
7589 </p>
7590 </sect>
7592 <sect>
7593 <heading>Permissions and owners</heading>
7596 The rules in this section are guidelines for general use.
7597 If necessary you may deviate from the details below.
7598 However, if you do so you must make sure that what is done
7599 is secure and you should try to be as consistent as possible
7600 with the rest of the system. You should probably also
7601 discuss it on <prgn>debian-devel</prgn> first.
7602 </p>
7605 Files should be owned by <tt>root:root</tt>, and made
7606 writable only by the owner and universally readable (and
7607 executable, if appropriate), that is mode 644 or 755.
7608 </p>
7611 Directories should be mode 755 or (for group-writability)
7612 mode 2775. The ownership of the directory should be
7613 consistent with its mode: if a directory is mode 2775, it
7614 should be owned by the group that needs write access to
7615 it.<footnote>
7617 When a package is upgraded, and the owner or permissions
7618 of a file included in the package has changed, dpkg
7619 arranges for the ownership and permissions to be
7620 correctly set upon installation. However, this does not
7621 extend to directories; the permissions and ownership of
7622 directories already on the system does not change on
7623 install or upgrade of packages. This makes sense, since
7624 otherwise common directories like <tt>/usr</tt> would
7625 always be in flux. To correctly change permissions of a
7626 directory the package owns, explicit action is required,
7627 usually in the <tt>postinst</tt> script. Care must be
7628 taken to handle downgrades as well, in that case.
7629 </p>
7630 </footnote>
7631 </p>
7635 Setuid and setgid executables should be mode 4755 or 2755
7636 respectively, and owned by the appropriate user or group.
7637 They should not be made unreadable (modes like 4711 or
7638 2711 or even 4111); doing so achieves no extra security,
7639 because anyone can find the binary in the freely available
7640 Debian package; it is merely inconvenient. For the same
7641 reason you should not restrict read or execute permissions
7642 on non-set-id executables.
7643 </p>
7646 Some setuid programs need to be restricted to particular
7647 sets of users, using file permissions. In this case they
7648 should be owned by the uid to which they are set-id, and by
7649 the group which should be allowed to execute them. They
7650 should have mode 4754; again there is no point in making
7651 them unreadable to those users who must not be allowed to
7652 execute them.
7653 </p>
7656 It is possible to arrange that the system administrator can
7657 reconfigure the package to correspond to their local
7658 security policy by changing the permissions on a binary:
7659 they can do this by using <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>, as
7660 described below.<footnote>
7661 Ordinary files installed by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> (as
7662 opposed to <tt>conffile</tt>s and other similar objects)
7663 normally have their permissions reset to the distributed
7664 permissions when the package is reinstalled. However,
7665 the use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> overrides this
7666 default behavior. If you use this method, you should
7667 remember to describe <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> in
7668 the package documentation; being a relatively new
7669 addition to Debian, it is probably not yet well-known.
7670 </footnote>
7671 Another method you should consider is to create a group for
7672 people allowed to use the program(s) and make any setuid
7673 executables executable only by that group.
7674 </p>
7677 If you need to create a new user or group for your package
7678 there are two possibilities. Firstly, you may need to
7679 make some files in the binary package be owned by this
7680 user or group, or you may need to compile the user or
7681 group id (rather than just the name) into the binary
7682 (though this latter should be avoided if possible, as in
7683 this case you need a statically allocated id).</p>
7686 If you need a statically allocated id, you must ask for a
7687 user or group id from the <tt>base-passwd</tt> maintainer,
7688 and must not release the package until you have been
7689 allocated one. Once you have been allocated one you must
7690 either make the package depend on a version of the
7691 <tt>base-passwd</tt> package with the id present in
7692 <file>/etc/passwd</file> or <file>/etc/group</file>, or arrange for
7693 your package to create the user or group itself with the
7694 correct id (using <tt>adduser</tt>) in its
7695 <prgn>preinst</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn>. (Doing it in
7696 the <prgn>postinst</prgn> is to be preferred if it is
7697 possible, otherwise a pre-dependency will be needed on the
7698 <tt>adduser</tt> package.)
7699 </p>
7702 On the other hand, the program might be able to determine
7703 the uid or gid from the user or group name at runtime, so
7704 that a dynamically allocated id can be used. In this case
7705 you should choose an appropriate user or group name,
7706 discussing this on <prgn>debian-devel</prgn> and checking
7707 with the <package/base-passwd/ maintainer that it is unique and that
7708 they do not wish you to use a statically allocated id
7709 instead. When this has been checked you must arrange for
7710 your package to create the user or group if necessary using
7711 <prgn>adduser</prgn> in the <prgn>preinst</prgn> or
7712 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script (again, the latter is to be
7713 preferred if it is possible).
7714 </p>
7717 Note that changing the numeric value of an id associated
7718 with a name is very difficult, and involves searching the
7719 file system for all appropriate files. You need to think
7720 carefully whether a static or dynamic id is required, since
7721 changing your mind later will cause problems.
7722 </p>
7724 <sect1><heading>The use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn></heading>
7726 This section is not intended as policy, but as a
7727 description of the use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>.
7728 </p>
7731 If a system administrator wishes to have a file (or
7732 directory or other such thing) installed with owner and
7733 permissions different from those in the distributed Debian
7734 package, they can use the <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>
7735 program to instruct <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to use the different
7736 settings every time the file is installed. Thus the
7737 package maintainer should distribute the files with their
7738 normal permissions, and leave it for the system
7739 administrator to make any desired changes. For example, a
7740 daemon which is normally required to be setuid root, but
7741 in certain situations could be used without being setuid,
7742 should be installed setuid in the <tt>.deb</tt>. Then the
7743 local system administrator can change this if they wish.
7744 If there are two standard ways of doing it, the package
7745 maintainer can use <tt>debconf</tt> to find out the
7746 preference, and call <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> in the
7747 maintainer script if necessary to accommodate the system
7748 administrator's choice. Care must be taken during
7749 upgrades to not override an existing setting.
7750 </p>
7753 Given the above, <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> is
7754 essentially a tool for system administrators and would not
7755 normally be needed in the maintainer scripts. There is
7756 one type of situation, though, where calls to
7757 <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> would be needed in the
7758 maintainer scripts, and that involves packages which use
7759 dynamically allocated user or group ids. In such a
7760 situation, something like the following idiom can be very
7761 helpful in the package's <prgn>postinst</prgn>, where
7762 <tt>sysuser</tt> is a dynamically allocated id:
7763 <example>
7764 for i in /usr/bin/foo /usr/sbin/bar
7766 # only do something when no setting exists
7767 if ! dpkg-statoverride --list $i >/dev/null 2>&1
7768 then
7769 #include: debconf processing, question about foo and bar
7770 if [ "$RET" = "true" ] ; then
7771 dpkg-statoverride --update --add sysuser root 4755 $i
7774 done
7775 </example>
7776 The corresponding <tt>dpkg-statoverride --remove</tt>
7777 calls can then be made unconditionally when the package is
7778 purged.
7779 </p>
7780 </sect1>
7781 </sect>
7782 </chapt>
7785 <chapt id="customized-programs">
7786 <heading>Customized programs</heading>
7788 <sect id="arch-spec">
7789 <heading>Architecture specification strings</heading>
7792 If a program needs to specify an <em>architecture specification
7793 string</em> in some place, it should select one of the
7794 strings provided by <tt>dpkg-architecture -L</tt>. The
7795 strings are in the format
7796 <tt><var>os</var>-<var>arch</var></tt>, though the OS part
7797 is sometimes elided, as when the OS is Linux.<footnote>
7798 <p>Currently, the strings are:
7799 i386 ia64 alpha amd64 armeb arm hppa m32r m68k mips
7800 mipsel powerpc ppc64 s390 s390x sh3 sh3eb sh4 sh4eb
7801 sparc darwin-i386 darwin-ia64 darwin-alpha darwin-amd64
7802 darwin-armeb darwin-arm darwin-hppa darwin-m32r
7803 darwin-m68k darwin-mips darwin-mipsel darwin-powerpc
7804 darwin-ppc64 darwin-s390 darwin-s390x darwin-sh3
7805 darwin-sh3eb darwin-sh4 darwin-sh4eb darwin-sparc
7806 freebsd-i386 freebsd-ia64 freebsd-alpha freebsd-amd64
7807 freebsd-armeb freebsd-arm freebsd-hppa freebsd-m32r
7808 freebsd-m68k freebsd-mips freebsd-mipsel freebsd-powerpc
7809 freebsd-ppc64 freebsd-s390 freebsd-s390x freebsd-sh3
7810 freebsd-sh3eb freebsd-sh4 freebsd-sh4eb freebsd-sparc
7811 kfreebsd-i386 kfreebsd-ia64 kfreebsd-alpha
7812 kfreebsd-amd64 kfreebsd-armeb kfreebsd-arm kfreebsd-hppa
7813 kfreebsd-m32r kfreebsd-m68k kfreebsd-mips
7814 kfreebsd-mipsel kfreebsd-powerpc kfreebsd-ppc64
7815 kfreebsd-s390 kfreebsd-s390x kfreebsd-sh3 kfreebsd-sh3eb
7816 kfreebsd-sh4 kfreebsd-sh4eb kfreebsd-sparc knetbsd-i386
7817 knetbsd-ia64 knetbsd-alpha knetbsd-amd64 knetbsd-armeb
7818 knetbsd-arm knetbsd-hppa knetbsd-m32r knetbsd-m68k
7819 knetbsd-mips knetbsd-mipsel knetbsd-powerpc
7820 knetbsd-ppc64 knetbsd-s390 knetbsd-s390x knetbsd-sh3
7821 knetbsd-sh3eb knetbsd-sh4 knetbsd-sh4eb knetbsd-sparc
7822 netbsd-i386 netbsd-ia64 netbsd-alpha netbsd-amd64
7823 netbsd-armeb netbsd-arm netbsd-hppa netbsd-m32r
7824 netbsd-m68k netbsd-mips netbsd-mipsel netbsd-powerpc
7825 netbsd-ppc64 netbsd-s390 netbsd-s390x netbsd-sh3
7826 netbsd-sh3eb netbsd-sh4 netbsd-sh4eb netbsd-sparc
7827 openbsd-i386 openbsd-ia64 openbsd-alpha openbsd-amd64
7828 openbsd-armeb openbsd-arm openbsd-hppa openbsd-m32r
7829 openbsd-m68k openbsd-mips openbsd-mipsel openbsd-powerpc
7830 openbsd-ppc64 openbsd-s390 openbsd-s390x openbsd-sh3
7831 openbsd-sh3eb openbsd-sh4 openbsd-sh4eb openbsd-sparc
7832 hurd-i386 hurd-ia64 hurd-alpha hurd-amd64 hurd-armeb
7833 hurd-arm hurd-hppa hurd-m32r hurd-m68k hurd-mips
7834 hurd-mipsel hurd-powerpc hurd-ppc64 hurd-s390 hurd-s390x
7835 hurd-sh3 hurd-sh3eb hurd-sh4 hurd-sh4eb hurd-sparc
7836 </p>
7837 </footnote>
7838 </p>
7841 Note that we don't want to use
7842 <tt><var>arch</var>-debian-linux</tt> to apply to the rule
7843 <tt><var>architecture</var>-<var>vendor</var>-<var>os</var></tt>
7844 since this would make our programs incompatible with other
7845 Linux distributions. We also don't use something like
7846 <tt><var>arch</var>-unknown-linux</tt>, since the
7847 <tt>unknown</tt> does not look very good.
7848 </p>
7849 </sect>
7851 <sect>
7852 <heading>Daemons</heading>
7855 The configuration files <file>/etc/services</file>,
7856 <file>/etc/protocols</file>, and <file>/etc/rpc</file> are managed
7857 by the <prgn>netbase</prgn> package and must not be modified
7858 by other packages.
7859 </p>
7862 If a package requires a new entry in one of these files, the
7863 maintainer should get in contact with the
7864 <prgn>netbase</prgn> maintainer, who will add the entries
7865 and release a new version of the <prgn>netbase</prgn>
7866 package.
7867 </p>
7870 The configuration file <file>/etc/inetd.conf</file> must not be
7871 modified by the package's scripts except via the
7872 <prgn>update-inetd</prgn> script or the
7873 <file>DebianNet.pm</file> Perl module. See their documentation
7874 for details on how to add entries.
7875 </p>
7878 If a package wants to install an example entry into
7879 <file>/etc/inetd.conf</file>, the entry must be preceded with
7880 exactly one hash character (<tt>#</tt>). Such lines are
7881 treated as "commented out by user" by the
7882 <prgn>update-inetd</prgn> script and are not changed or
7883 activated during package updates.
7884 </p>
7885 </sect>
7887 <sect>
7888 <heading>Using pseudo-ttys and modifying wtmp, utmp and
7889 lastlog</heading>
7892 Some programs need to create pseudo-ttys. This should be done
7893 using Unix98 ptys if the C library supports it. The resulting
7894 program must not be installed setuid root, unless that
7895 is required for other functionality.
7896 </p>
7899 The files <file>/var/run/utmp</file>, <file>/var/log/wtmp</file> and
7900 <file>/var/log/lastlog</file> must be installed writable by
7901 group <tt>utmp</tt>. Programs which need to modify those
7902 files must be installed setgid <tt>utmp</tt>.
7903 </p>
7904 </sect>
7906 <sect>
7907 <heading>Editors and pagers</heading>
7910 Some programs have the ability to launch an editor or pager
7911 program to edit or display a text document. Since there are
7912 lots of different editors and pagers available in the Debian
7913 distribution, the system administrator and each user should
7914 have the possibility to choose their preferred editor and
7915 pager.
7916 </p>
7919 In addition, every program should choose a good default
7920 editor/pager if none is selected by the user or system
7921 administrator.
7922 </p>
7925 Thus, every program that launches an editor or pager must
7926 use the EDITOR or PAGER environment variable to determine
7927 the editor or pager the user wishes to use. If these
7928 variables are not set, the programs <file>/usr/bin/editor</file>
7929 and <file>/usr/bin/pager</file> should be used, respectively.
7930 </p>
7933 These two files are managed through the <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
7934 "alternatives" mechanism. Thus every package providing an
7935 editor or pager must call the
7936 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> script to register these
7937 programs.
7938 </p>
7941 If it is very hard to adapt a program to make use of the
7942 EDITOR or PAGER variables, that program may be configured to
7943 use <file>/usr/bin/sensible-editor</file> and
7944 <file>/usr/bin/sensible-pager</file> as the editor or pager
7945 program respectively. These are two scripts provided in the
7946 Debian base system that check the EDITOR and PAGER variables
7947 and launch the appropriate program, and fall back to
7948 <file>/usr/bin/editor</file> and <file>/usr/bin/pager</file> if the
7949 variable is not set.
7950 </p>
7953 A program may also use the VISUAL environment variable to
7954 determine the user's choice of editor. If it exists, it
7955 should take precedence over EDITOR. This is in fact what
7956 <file>/usr/bin/sensible-editor</file> does.
7957 </p>
7960 It is not required for a package to depend on
7961 <tt>editor</tt> and <tt>pager</tt>, nor is it required for a
7962 package to provide such virtual packages.<footnote>
7963 The Debian base system already provides an editor and a
7964 pager program.
7965 </footnote>
7966 </p>
7967 </sect>
7969 <sect id="web-appl">
7970 <heading>Web servers and applications</heading>
7973 This section describes the locations and URLs that should
7974 be used by all web servers and web applications in the
7975 Debian system.
7976 </p>
7979 <enumlist>
7980 <item>
7981 Cgi-bin executable files are installed in the
7982 directory
7983 <example compact="compact">
7984 /usr/lib/cgi-bin/<var>cgi-bin-name</var>
7985 </example>
7986 and should be referred to as
7987 <example compact="compact">
7988 http://localhost/cgi-bin/<var>cgi-bin-name</var>
7989 </example>
7991 </item>
7993 <item>
7994 <p>Access to HTML documents</p>
7997 HTML documents for a package are stored in
7998 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>
7999 and can be referred to as
8000 <example compact="compact">
8001 http://localhost/doc/<var>package</var>/<var>filename</var>
8002 </example>
8003 </p>
8006 The web server should restrict access to the document
8007 tree so that only clients on the same host can read
8008 the documents. If the web server does not support such
8009 access controls, then it should not provide access at
8010 all, or ask about providing access during installation.
8011 </p>
8012 </item>
8014 <item>
8015 <p>Access to images</p>
8017 It is recommended that images for a package be stored
8018 in <tt>/usr/share/images/<var>package</var></tt> and
8019 may be referred to through an alias <tt>/images/</tt>
8021 <example>
8022 http://localhost/images/&lt;package&gt;/&lt;filename&gt;
8023 </example>
8025 </p>
8026 </item>
8028 <item>
8029 <p>Web Document Root</p>
8032 Web Applications should try to avoid storing files in
8033 the Web Document Root. Instead they should use the
8034 /usr/share/doc/<var>package</var> directory for
8035 documents and register the Web Application via the
8036 <package>doc-base</package> package. If access to the
8037 web document root is unavoidable then use
8038 <example compact="compact">
8039 /var/www
8040 </example>
8041 as the Document Root. This might be just a symbolic
8042 link to the location where the system administrator
8043 has put the real document root.
8044 </p>
8045 </item>
8046 <item><p>Providing httpd and/or httpd-cgi</p>
8048 All web servers should provide the virtual package
8049 <tt>httpd</tt>. If a web server has CGI support it should
8050 provide <tt>httpd-cgi</tt> additionally.
8051 </p>
8053 All web applications which do not contain CGI scripts should
8054 depend on <tt>httpd</tt>, all those web applications which
8055 <tt>do</tt> contain CGI scripts, should depend on
8056 <tt>httpd-cgi</tt>.
8057 </p>
8058 </item>
8059 </enumlist>
8060 </p>
8061 </sect>
8063 <sect id="mail-transport-agents">
8064 <heading>Mail transport, delivery and user agents</heading>
8067 Debian packages which process electronic mail, whether mail
8068 user agents (MUAs) or mail transport agents (MTAs), must
8069 ensure that they are compatible with the configuration
8070 decisions below. Failure to do this may result in lost
8071 mail, broken <tt>From:</tt> lines, and other serious brain
8072 damage!
8073 </p>
8076 The mail spool is <file>/var/mail</file> and the interface to
8077 send a mail message is <file>/usr/sbin/sendmail</file> (as per
8078 the FHS). On older systems, the mail spool may be
8079 physically located in <file>/var/spool/mail</file>, but all
8080 access to the mail spool should be via the
8081 <file>/var/mail</file> symlink. The mail spool is part of the
8082 base system and not part of the MTA package.
8083 </p>
8086 All Debian MUAs, MTAs, MDAs and other mailbox accessing
8087 programs (such as IMAP daemons) must lock the mailbox in an
8088 NFS-safe way. This means that <tt>fcntl()</tt> locking must
8089 be combined with dot locking. To avoid deadlocks, a program
8090 should use <tt>fcntl()</tt> first and dot locking after
8091 this, or alternatively implement the two locking methods in
8092 a non blocking way<footnote>
8093 If it is not possible to establish both locks, the
8094 system shouldn't wait for the second lock to be
8095 established, but remove the first lock, wait a (random)
8096 time, and start over locking again.
8097 </footnote>. Using the functions <tt>maillock</tt> and
8098 <tt>mailunlock</tt> provided by the
8099 <tt>liblockfile*</tt><footnote>
8100 You will need to depend on <tt>liblockfile1 (&gt;&gt;1.01)</tt>
8101 to use these functions.
8102 </footnote> packages is the recommended way to realize this.
8103 </p>
8106 Mailboxes are generally either mode 600 and owned by
8107 <var>user</var> or mode 660 and owned by
8108 <tt><var>user</var>:mail</tt><footnote>
8109 There are two traditional permission schemes for mail spools:
8110 mode 600 with all mail delivery done by processes running as
8111 the destination user, or mode 660 and owned by group mail with
8112 mail delivery done by a process running as a system user in
8113 group mail. Historically, Debian required mode 660 mail
8114 spools to enable the latter model, but that model has become
8115 increasingly uncommon and the principle of least privilege
8116 indicates that mail systems that use the first model should
8117 use permissions of 600. If delivery to programs is permitted,
8118 it's easier to keep the mail system secure if the delivery
8119 agent runs as the destination user. Debian Policy therefore
8120 permits either scheme.
8121 </footnote>. The local system administrator may choose a
8122 different permission scheme; packages should not make
8123 assumptions about the permission and ownership of mailboxes
8124 unless required (such as when creating a new mailbox). A MUA
8125 may remove a mailbox (unless it has nonstandard permissions) in
8126 which case the MTA or another MUA must recreate it if needed.
8127 </p>
8130 The mail spool is 2775 <tt>root:mail</tt>, and MUAs should
8131 be setgid mail to do the locking mentioned above (and
8132 must obviously avoid accessing other users' mailboxes
8133 using this privilege).</p>
8136 <file>/etc/aliases</file> is the source file for the system mail
8137 aliases (e.g., postmaster, usenet, etc.), it is the one
8138 which the sysadmin and <prgn>postinst</prgn> scripts may
8139 edit. After <file>/etc/aliases</file> is edited the program or
8140 human editing it must call <prgn>newaliases</prgn>. All MTA
8141 packages must come with a <prgn>newaliases</prgn> program,
8142 even if it does nothing, but older MTA packages did not do
8143 this so programs should not fail if <prgn>newaliases</prgn>
8144 cannot be found. Note that because of this, all MTA
8145 packages must have <tt>Provides</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt> and
8146 <tt>Replaces: mail-transport-agent</tt> control file
8147 fields.
8148 </p>
8151 The convention of writing <tt>forward to
8152 <var>address</var></tt> in the mailbox itself is not
8153 supported. Use a <tt>.forward</tt> file instead.</p>
8156 The <prgn>rmail</prgn> program used by UUCP
8157 for incoming mail should be <file>/usr/sbin/rmail</file>.
8158 Likewise, <prgn>rsmtp</prgn>, for receiving
8159 batch-SMTP-over-UUCP, should be <file>/usr/sbin/rsmtp</file> if it
8160 is supported.</p>
8163 If your package needs to know what hostname to use on (for
8164 example) outgoing news and mail messages which are generated
8165 locally, you should use the file <file>/etc/mailname</file>. It
8166 will contain the portion after the username and <tt>@</tt>
8167 (at) sign for email addresses of users on the machine
8168 (followed by a newline).
8169 </p>
8172 Such a package should check for the existence of this file
8173 when it is being configured. If it exists, it should be
8174 used without comment, although an MTA's configuration script
8175 may wish to prompt the user even if it finds that this file
8176 exists. If the file does not exist, the package should
8177 prompt the user for the value (preferably using
8178 <prgn>debconf</prgn>) and store it in <file>/etc/mailname</file>
8179 as well as using it in the package's configuration. The
8180 prompt should make it clear that the name will not just be
8181 used by that package. For example, in this situation the
8182 <tt>inn</tt> package could say something like:
8183 <example compact="compact">
8184 Please enter the "mail name" of your system. This is the
8185 hostname portion of the address to be shown on outgoing
8186 news and mail messages. The default is
8187 <var>syshostname</var>, your system's host name. Mail
8188 name ["<var>syshostname</var>"]:
8189 </example>
8190 where <var>syshostname</var> is the output of <tt>hostname
8191 --fqdn</tt>.
8192 </p>
8193 </sect>
8195 <sect>
8196 <heading>News system configuration</heading>
8199 All the configuration files related to the NNTP (news)
8200 servers and clients should be located under
8201 <file>/etc/news</file>.</p>
8204 There are some configuration issues that apply to a number
8205 of news clients and server packages on the machine. These
8206 are:
8208 <taglist>
8209 <tag><file>/etc/news/organization</file></tag>
8210 <item>
8211 A string which should appear as the
8212 organization header for all messages posted
8213 by NNTP clients on the machine
8214 </item>
8216 <tag><file>/etc/news/server</file></tag>
8217 <item>
8218 Contains the FQDN of the upstream NNTP
8219 server, or localhost if the local machine is
8220 an NNTP server.
8221 </item>
8222 </taglist>
8224 Other global files may be added as required for cross-package news
8225 configuration.
8226 </p>
8227 </sect>
8230 <sect>
8231 <heading>Programs for the X Window System</heading>
8233 <sect1>
8234 <heading>Providing X support and package priorities</heading>
8237 Programs that can be configured with support for the X
8238 Window System must be configured to do so and must declare
8239 any package dependencies necessary to satisfy their
8240 runtime requirements when using the X Window System. If
8241 such a package is of higher priority than the X packages
8242 on which it depends, it is required that either the
8243 X-specific components be split into a separate package, or
8244 that an alternative version of the package, which includes
8245 X support, be provided, or that the package's priority be
8246 lowered.
8247 </p>
8248 </sect1>
8250 <sect1>
8251 <heading>Packages providing an X server</heading>
8254 Packages that provide an X server that, directly or
8255 indirectly, communicates with real input and display
8256 hardware should declare in their control data that they
8257 provide the virtual package <tt>xserver</tt>.<footnote>
8258 This implements current practice, and provides an
8259 actual policy for usage of the <tt>xserver</tt>
8260 virtual package which appears in the virtual packages
8261 list. In a nutshell, X servers that interface
8262 directly with the display and input hardware or via
8263 another subsystem (e.g., GGI) should provide
8264 <tt>xserver</tt>. Things like <tt>Xvfb</tt>,
8265 <tt>Xnest</tt>, and <tt>Xprt</tt> should not.
8266 </footnote>
8267 </p>
8268 </sect1>
8270 <sect1>
8271 <heading>Packages providing a terminal emulator</heading>
8274 Packages that provide a terminal emulator for the X Window
8275 System which meet the criteria listed below should declare
8276 in their control data that they provide the virtual
8277 package <tt>x-terminal-emulator</tt>. They should also
8278 register themselves as an alternative for
8279 <file>/usr/bin/x-terminal-emulator</file>, with a priority of
8281 </p>
8284 To be an <tt>x-terminal-emulator</tt>, a program must:
8285 <list compact="compact">
8286 <item>
8287 Be able to emulate a DEC VT100 terminal, or a
8288 compatible terminal.
8289 </item>
8291 <item>
8292 Support the command-line option <tt>-e
8293 <var>command</var></tt>, which creates a new
8294 terminal window<footnote>
8295 "New terminal window" does not necessarily mean
8296 a new top-level X window directly parented by
8297 the window manager; it could, if the terminal
8298 emulator application were so coded, be a new
8299 "view" in a multiple-document interface (MDI).
8300 </footnote>
8301 and runs the specified <var>command</var>,
8302 interpreting the entirety of the rest of the command
8303 line as a command to pass straight to exec, in the
8304 manner that <tt>xterm</tt> does.
8305 </item>
8307 <item>
8308 Support the command-line option <tt>-T
8309 <var>title</var></tt>, which creates a new terminal
8310 window with the window title <var>title</var>.
8311 </item>
8312 </list>
8313 </p>
8314 </sect1>
8316 <sect1>
8317 <heading>Packages providing a window manager</heading>
8320 Packages that provide a window manager should declare in
8321 their control data that they provide the virtual package
8322 <tt>x-window-manager</tt>. They should also register
8323 themselves as an alternative for
8324 <file>/usr/bin/x-window-manager</file>, with a priority
8325 calculated as follows:
8326 <list compact="compact">
8327 <item>
8328 Start with a priority of 20.
8329 </item>
8331 <item>
8332 If the window manager supports the Debian menu
8333 system, add 20 points if this support is available
8334 in the package's default configuration (i.e., no
8335 configuration files belonging to the system or user
8336 have to be edited to activate the feature); if
8337 configuration files must be modified, add only 10
8338 points.
8339 </p>
8340 </item>
8342 <item>
8343 If the window manager complies with <url
8344 id="http://www.freedesktop.org/Standards/wm-spec"
8345 name="The Window Manager Specification Project">,
8346 written by the <url id="http://www.freedesktop.org/"
8347 name="Free Desktop Group">, add 40 points.
8348 </item>
8350 <item>
8351 If the window manager permits the X session to be
8352 restarted using a <em>different</em> window manager
8353 (without killing the X server) in its default
8354 configuration, add 10 points; otherwise add none.
8355 </item>
8356 </list>
8357 </p>
8358 </sect1>
8360 <sect1>
8361 <heading>Packages providing fonts</heading>
8364 Packages that provide fonts for the X Window
8365 System<footnote>
8366 For the purposes of Debian Policy, a "font for the X
8367 Window System" is one which is accessed via X protocol
8368 requests. Fonts for the Linux console, for PostScript
8369 renderer, or any other purpose, do not fit this
8370 definition. Any tool which makes such fonts available
8371 to the X Window System, however, must abide by this
8372 font policy.
8373 </footnote>
8374 must do a number of things to ensure that they are both
8375 available without modification of the X or font server
8376 configuration, and that they do not corrupt files used by
8377 other font packages to register information about
8378 themselves.
8379 <enumlist>
8380 <item>
8381 Fonts of any type supported by the X Window System
8382 must be in a separate binary package from any
8383 executables, libraries, or documentation (except
8384 that specific to the fonts shipped, such as their
8385 license information). If one or more of the fonts
8386 so packaged are necessary for proper operation of
8387 the package with which they are associated the font
8388 package may be Recommended; if the fonts merely
8389 provide an enhancement, a Suggests relationship may
8390 be used. Packages must not Depend on font
8391 packages.<footnote>
8392 This is because the X server may retrieve fonts
8393 from the local file system or over the network
8394 from an X font server; the Debian package system
8395 is empowered to deal only with the local
8396 file system.
8397 </footnote>
8398 </item>
8400 <item>
8401 BDF fonts must be converted to PCF fonts with the
8402 <prgn>bdftopcf</prgn> utility (available in the
8403 <tt>xfonts-utils</tt> package, <prgn>gzip</prgn>ped, and
8404 placed in a directory that corresponds to their
8405 resolution:
8406 <list compact="compact">
8407 <item>
8408 100 dpi fonts must be placed in
8409 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/100dpi/</file>.
8410 </item>
8412 <item>
8413 75 dpi fonts must be placed in
8414 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/75dpi/</file>.
8415 </item>
8417 <item>
8418 Character-cell fonts, cursor fonts, and other
8419 low-resolution fonts must be placed in
8420 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/misc/</file>.
8421 </item>
8422 </list>
8423 </item>
8425 <item>
8426 Type 1 fonts must be placed in
8427 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/Type1/</file>. If font
8428 metric files are available, they must be placed here
8429 as well.
8430 </item>
8432 <item>
8433 Subdirectories of <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/</file>
8434 other than those listed above must be neither
8435 created nor used. (The <file>PEX</file>, <file>CID</file>,
8436 <file>Speedo</file>, and <file>cyrillic</file> directories
8437 are excepted for historical reasons, but installation of
8438 files into these directories remains discouraged.)
8439 </item>
8441 <item>
8442 Font packages may, instead of placing files directly
8443 in the X font directories listed above, provide
8444 symbolic links in that font directory pointing to
8445 the files' actual location in the filesystem. Such
8446 a location must comply with the FHS.
8447 </item>
8449 <item>
8450 Font packages should not contain both 75dpi and
8451 100dpi versions of a font. If both are available,
8452 they should be provided in separate binary packages
8453 with <tt>-75dpi</tt> or <tt>-100dpi</tt> appended to
8454 the names of the packages containing the
8455 corresponding fonts.
8456 </item>
8458 <item>
8459 Fonts destined for the <file>misc</file> subdirectory
8460 should not be included in the same package as 75dpi
8461 or 100dpi fonts; instead, they should be provided in
8462 a separate package with <tt>-misc</tt> appended to
8463 its name.
8464 </item>
8466 <item>
8467 Font packages must not provide the files
8468 <file>fonts.dir</file>, <file>fonts.alias</file>, or
8469 <file>fonts.scale</file> in a font directory:
8470 <list>
8471 <item>
8472 <file>fonts.dir</file> files must not be provided at all.
8473 </item>
8475 <item>
8476 <file>fonts.alias</file> and <file>fonts.scale</file>
8477 files, if needed, should be provided in the
8478 directory
8479 <file>/etc/X11/fonts/<var>fontdir</var>/<var>package</var>.<var>extension</var></file>,
8480 where <var>fontdir</var> is the name of the
8481 subdirectory of
8482 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/</file> where the
8483 package's corresponding fonts are stored
8484 (e.g., <tt>75dpi</tt> or <tt>misc</tt>),
8485 <var>package</var> is the name of the package
8486 that provides these fonts, and
8487 <var>extension</var> is either <tt>scale</tt>
8488 or <tt>alias</tt>, whichever corresponds to
8489 the file contents.
8490 </item>
8491 </list>
8492 </item>
8494 <item>
8495 Font packages must declare a dependency on
8496 <tt>xfonts-utils</tt> in their control
8497 data.
8498 </item>
8500 <item>
8501 Font packages that provide one or more
8502 <file>fonts.scale</file> files as described above must
8503 invoke <prgn>update-fonts-scale</prgn> on each
8504 directory into which they installed fonts
8505 <em>before</em> invoking
8506 <prgn>update-fonts-dir</prgn> on that directory.
8507 This invocation must occur in both the
8508 <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all arguments) and
8509 <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all arguments except
8510 <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
8511 </item>
8513 <item>
8514 Font packages that provide one or more
8515 <file>fonts.alias</file> files as described above must
8516 invoke <prgn>update-fonts-alias</prgn> on each
8517 directory into which they installed fonts. This
8518 invocation must occur in both the
8519 <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all arguments) and
8520 <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all arguments except
8521 <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
8522 </item>
8524 <item>
8525 Font packages must invoke
8526 <prgn>update-fonts-dir</prgn> on each directory into
8527 which they installed fonts. This invocation must
8528 occur in both the <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all
8529 arguments) and <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all
8530 arguments except <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
8531 </item>
8533 <item>
8534 Font packages must not provide alias names for the
8535 fonts they include which collide with alias names
8536 already in use by fonts already packaged.
8537 </item>
8539 <item>
8540 Font packages must not provide fonts with the same
8541 XLFD registry name as another font already packaged.
8542 </item>
8543 </enumlist>
8544 </p>
8545 </sect1>
8547 <sect1>
8548 <heading>Application defaults files</heading>
8551 Application defaults files must be installed in the
8552 directory <file>/etc/X11/app-defaults/</file> (use of a
8553 localized subdirectory of <file>/etc/X11/</file> as described
8554 in the <em>X Toolkit Intrinsics - C Language
8555 Interface</em> manual is also permitted). They must be
8556 registered as <tt>conffile</tt>s or handled as
8557 configuration files.
8558 </p>
8561 Customization of programs' X resources may also be
8562 supported with the provision of a file with the same name
8563 as that of the package placed in the
8564 <file>/etc/X11/Xresources/</file> directory, which must
8565 registered as a <tt>conffile</tt> or handled as a
8566 configuration file.<footnote>
8567 Note that this mechanism is not the same as using
8568 app-defaults; app-defaults are tied to the client
8569 binary on the local file system, whereas X resources
8570 are stored in the X server and affect all connecting
8571 clients.
8572 </footnote>
8573 </p>
8574 </sect1>
8576 <sect1>
8577 <heading>Installation directory issues</heading>
8580 Historically, packages using the X Window System used a
8581 separate set of installation directories from other packages.
8582 This practice has been discontinued and packages using the X
8583 Window System should now generally be installed in the same
8584 directories as any other package. Specifically, packages must
8585 not install files under the <file>/usr/X11R6/</file> directory
8586 and the <file>/usr/X11R6/</file> directory hierarchy should be
8587 regarded as obsolete.
8588 </p>
8591 Include files previously installed under
8592 <file>/usr/X11R6/include/X11/</file> should be installed into
8593 <file>/usr/include/X11/</file>. For files previously
8594 installed into subdirectories of
8595 <file>/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/</file>, package maintainers should
8596 determine if subdirectories of <file>/usr/lib/</file> and
8597 <file>/usr/share/</file> can be used. If not, a subdirectory
8598 of <file>/usr/lib/X11/</file> should be used.
8599 </p>
8602 Configuration files for window, display, or session managers
8603 or other applications that are tightly integrated with the X
8604 Window System may be placed in a subdirectory
8605 of <file>/etc/X11/</file> corresponding to the package name.
8606 Other X Window System applications should use
8607 the <file>/etc/</file> directory unless otherwise mandated by
8608 policy (such as for <ref id="appdefaults">).
8609 </p>
8610 </sect1>
8612 <sect1>
8613 <heading>The OSF/Motif and OpenMotif libraries</heading>
8616 <em>Programs that require the non-DFSG-compliant OSF/Motif or
8617 OpenMotif libraries</em><footnote>
8618 OSF/Motif and OpenMotif are collectively referred to as
8619 "Motif" in this policy document.
8620 </footnote>
8621 should be compiled against and tested with LessTif (a free
8622 re-implementation of Motif) instead. If the maintainer
8623 judges that the program or programs do not work
8624 sufficiently well with LessTif to be distributed and
8625 supported, but do so when compiled against Motif, then two
8626 versions of the package should be created; one linked
8627 statically against Motif and with <tt>-smotif</tt>
8628 appended to the package name, and one linked dynamically
8629 against Motif and with <tt>-dmotif</tt> appended to the
8630 package name.
8631 </p>
8634 Both Motif-linked versions are dependent
8635 upon non-DFSG-compliant software and thus cannot be
8636 uploaded to the <em>main</em> distribution; if the
8637 software is itself DFSG-compliant it may be uploaded to
8638 the <em>contrib</em> distribution. While known existing
8639 versions of Motif permit unlimited redistribution of
8640 binaries linked against the library (whether statically or
8641 dynamically), it is the package maintainer's
8642 responsibility to determine whether this is permitted by
8643 the license of the copy of Motif in their possession.
8644 </p>
8645 </sect1>
8646 </sect>
8648 <sect id="perl">
8649 <heading>Perl programs and modules</heading>
8652 Perl programs and modules should follow the current Perl policy.
8653 </p>
8656 The Perl policy can be found in the <tt>perl-policy</tt>
8657 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
8658 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
8659 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/perl-policy/"
8660 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/perl-policy/"></tt>.
8661 </p>
8662 </sect>
8664 <sect id="emacs">
8665 <heading>Emacs lisp programs</heading>
8668 Please refer to the "Debian Emacs Policy" for details of how to
8669 package emacs lisp programs.
8670 </p>
8673 The Emacs policy is available in
8674 <file>debian-emacs-policy.gz</file> of the
8675 <package>emacsen-common</package> package.
8676 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
8677 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/debian-emacs-policy"
8678 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/debian-emacs-policy"></tt>.
8679 </p>
8680 </sect>
8682 <sect>
8683 <heading>Games</heading>
8686 The permissions on <file>/var/games</file> are mode 755, owner
8687 <tt>root</tt> and group <tt>root</tt>.
8688 </p>
8691 Each game decides on its own security policy.</p>
8694 Games which require protected, privileged access to
8695 high-score files, saved games, etc., may be made
8696 set-<em>group</em>-id (mode 2755) and owned by
8697 <tt>root:games</tt>, and use files and directories with
8698 appropriate permissions (770 <tt>root:games</tt>, for
8699 example). They must not be made
8700 set-<em>user</em>-id, as this causes security problems. (If
8701 an attacker can subvert any set-user-id game they can
8702 overwrite the executable of any other, causing other players
8703 of these games to run a Trojan horse program. With a
8704 set-group-id game the attacker only gets access to less
8705 important game data, and if they can get at the other
8706 players' accounts at all it will take considerably more
8707 effort.)</p>
8710 Some packages, for example some fortune cookie programs, are
8711 configured by the upstream authors to install with their
8712 data files or other static information made unreadable so
8713 that they can only be accessed through set-id programs
8714 provided. You should not do this in a Debian package: anyone can
8715 download the <file>.deb</file> file and read the data from it,
8716 so there is no point making the files unreadable. Not
8717 making the files unreadable also means that you don't have
8718 to make so many programs set-id, which reduces the risk of a
8719 security hole.</p>
8722 As described in the FHS, binaries of games should be
8723 installed in the directory <file>/usr/games</file>. This also
8724 applies to games that use the X Window System. Manual pages
8725 for games (X and non-X games) should be installed in
8726 <file>/usr/share/man/man6</file>.</p>
8727 </sect>
8728 </chapt>
8731 <chapt id="docs">
8732 <heading>Documentation</heading>
8734 <sect>
8735 <heading>Manual pages</heading>
8738 You should install manual pages in <prgn>nroff</prgn> source
8739 form, in appropriate places under <file>/usr/share/man</file>.
8740 You should only use sections 1 to 9 (see the FHS for more
8741 details). You must not install a pre-formatted "cat page".
8742 </p>
8745 Each program, utility, and function should have an
8746 associated manual page included in the same package. It is
8747 suggested that all configuration files also have a manual
8748 page included as well. Manual pages for protocols and other
8749 auxiliary things are optional.
8750 </p>
8753 If no manual page is available, this is considered as a bug
8754 and should be reported to the Debian Bug Tracking System (the
8755 maintainer of the package is allowed to write this bug report
8756 themselves, if they so desire). Do not close the bug report
8757 until a proper man page is available.<footnote>
8758 It is not very hard to write a man page. See the
8759 <url id="http://www.schweikhardt.net/man_page_howto.html"
8760 name="Man-Page-HOWTO">,
8761 <manref name="man" section="7">, the examples
8762 created by <prgn>debmake</prgn> or <prgn>dh_make</prgn>,
8763 the helper programs <prgn>help2man</prgn>, or the
8764 directory <file>/usr/share/doc/man-db/examples</file>.
8765 </footnote>
8766 </p>
8769 You may forward a complaint about a missing man page to the
8770 upstream authors, and mark the bug as forwarded in the
8771 Debian bug tracking system. Even though the GNU Project do
8772 not in general consider the lack of a man page to be a bug,
8773 we do; if they tell you that they don't consider it a bug
8774 you should leave the bug in our bug tracking system open
8775 anyway.
8776 </p>
8779 Manual pages should be installed compressed using <tt>gzip -9</tt>.
8780 </p>
8783 If one man page needs to be accessible via several names it
8784 is better to use a symbolic link than the <file>.so</file>
8785 feature, but there is no need to fiddle with the relevant
8786 parts of the upstream source to change from <file>.so</file> to
8787 symlinks: don't do it unless it's easy. You should not
8788 create hard links in the manual page directories, nor put
8789 absolute filenames in <file>.so</file> directives. The filename
8790 in a <file>.so</file> in a man page should be relative to the
8791 base of the man page tree (usually
8792 <file>/usr/share/man</file>). If you do not create any links
8793 (whether symlinks, hard links, or <tt>.so</tt> directives)
8794 in the file system to the alternate names of the man page,
8795 then you should not rely on <prgn>man</prgn> finding your
8796 man page under those names based solely on the information in
8797 the man page's header.<footnote>
8798 Supporting this in <prgn>man</prgn> often requires
8799 unreasonable processing time to find a manual page or to
8800 report that none exists, and moves knowledge into man's
8801 database that would be better left in the file system.
8802 This support is therefore deprecated and will cease to
8803 be present in the future.
8804 </footnote>
8805 </p>
8808 Manual pages in locale-specific subdirectories of
8809 <file>/usr/share/man</file> should use either UTF-8 or the usual
8810 legacy encoding for that language (normally the one corresponding
8811 to the shortest relevant locale name in
8812 <file>/usr/share/i18n/SUPPORTED</file>). For example, pages under
8813 <file>/usr/share/man/fr</file> should use either UTF-8 or
8814 ISO-8859-1.<footnote>
8815 <prgn>man</prgn> will automatically detect whether UTF-8 is in
8816 use. In future, all manual pages will be required to use
8817 UTF-8.
8818 </footnote>
8819 </p>
8822 A country name (the <tt>DE</tt> in <tt>de_DE</tt>) should not be
8823 included in the subdirectory name unless it indicates a
8824 significant difference in the language, as this excludes
8825 speakers of the language in other countries.<footnote>
8826 At the time of writing, Chinese and Portuguese are the main
8827 languages with such differences, so <file>pt_BR</file>,
8828 <file>zh_CN</file>, and <file>zh_TW</file> are all allowed.
8829 </footnote>
8830 </p>
8833 Due to limitations in current implementations, all characters
8834 in the manual page source should be representable in the usual
8835 legacy encoding for that language, even if the file is
8836 actually encoded in UTF-8. Safe alternative ways to write many
8837 characters outside that range may be found in
8838 <manref name="groff_char" section="7">.
8839 </p>
8840 </sect>
8842 <sect>
8843 <heading>Info documents</heading>
8846 Info documents should be installed in <file>/usr/share/info</file>.
8847 They should be compressed with <tt>gzip -9</tt>.
8848 </p>
8851 Your package should call <prgn>install-info</prgn> to update
8852 the Info <file>dir</file> file in its <prgn>postinst</prgn>
8853 script when called with a <tt>configure</tt> argument, for
8854 example:
8855 <example compact="compact">
8856 install-info --quiet --section Development Development \
8857 /usr/share/info/foobar.info
8858 </example></p>
8861 It is a good idea to specify a section for the location of
8862 your program; this is done with the <tt>--section</tt>
8863 switch. To determine which section to use, you should look
8864 at <file>/usr/share/info/dir</file> on your system and choose the most
8865 relevant (or create a new section if none of the current
8866 sections are relevant). Note that the <tt>--section</tt>
8867 flag takes two arguments; the first is a regular expression
8868 to match (case-insensitively) against an existing section,
8869 the second is used when creating a new one.</p>
8872 You should remove the entries in the <prgn>prerm</prgn>
8873 script when called with a <tt>remove</tt> argument:
8874 <example compact="compact">
8875 install-info --quiet --remove /usr/share/info/foobar.info
8876 </example></p>
8879 If <prgn>install-info</prgn> cannot find a description entry
8880 in the Info file you must supply one. See <manref
8881 name="install-info" section="8"> for details.</p>
8882 </sect>
8884 <sect>
8885 <heading>Additional documentation</heading>
8888 Any additional documentation that comes with the package may
8889 be installed at the discretion of the package maintainer.
8890 Plain text documentation should be installed in the directory
8891 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>, where
8892 <var>package</var> is the name of the package, and
8893 compressed with <tt>gzip -9</tt> unless it is small.
8894 </p>
8897 If a package comes with large amounts of documentation which
8898 many users of the package will not require you should create
8899 a separate binary package to contain it, so that it does not
8900 take up disk space on the machines of users who do not need
8901 or want it installed.</p>
8904 It is often a good idea to put text information files
8905 (<file>README</file>s, changelogs, and so forth) that come with
8906 the source package in <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>
8907 in the binary package. However, you don't need to install
8908 the instructions for building and installing the package, of
8909 course!</p>
8912 Packages must not require the existence of any files in
8913 <file>/usr/share/doc/</file> in order to function
8914 <footnote>
8915 The system administrator should be able to
8916 delete files in <file>/usr/share/doc/</file> without causing
8917 any programs to break.
8918 </footnote>.
8919 Any files that are referenced by programs but are also
8920 useful as stand alone documentation should be installed under
8921 <file>/usr/share/<var>package</var>/</file> with symbolic links from
8922 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>.
8923 </p>
8926 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> may be a symbolic
8927 link to another directory in <file>/usr/share/doc</file> only if
8928 the two packages both come from the same source and the
8929 first package Depends on the second.<footnote>
8931 Please note that this does not override the section on
8932 changelog files below, so the file
8933 <file>/usr/share/<var>package</var>/changelog.Debian.gz</file>
8934 must refer to the changelog for the current version of
8935 <var>package</var> in question. In practice, this means
8936 that the sources of the target and the destination of the
8937 symlink must be the same (same source package and
8938 version).
8939 </p>
8940 </footnote>
8941 </p>
8944 Former Debian releases placed all additional documentation
8945 in <file>/usr/doc/<var>package</var></file>. This has been
8946 changed to <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>,
8947 and packages must not put documentation in the directory
8948 <file>/usr/doc/<var>package</var></file>. <footnote>
8949 At this phase of the transition, we no longer require a
8950 symbolic link in <file>/usr/doc/</file>. At a later point,
8951 policy shall change to make the symbolic links a bug.
8952 </footnote>
8953 </p>
8954 </sect>
8956 <sect>
8957 <heading>Preferred documentation formats</heading>
8960 The unification of Debian documentation is being carried out
8961 via HTML.</p>
8964 If your package comes with extensive documentation in a
8965 markup format that can be converted to various other formats
8966 you should if possible ship HTML versions in a binary
8967 package, in the directory
8968 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>appropriate-package</var></file> or
8969 its subdirectories.<footnote>
8970 The rationale: The important thing here is that HTML
8971 docs should be available in <em>some</em> package, not
8972 necessarily in the main binary package.
8973 </footnote>
8974 </p>
8977 Other formats such as PostScript may be provided at the
8978 package maintainer's discretion.
8979 </p>
8980 </sect>
8982 <sect id="copyrightfile">
8983 <heading>Copyright information</heading>
8986 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its
8987 copyright and distribution license in the file
8988 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>. This
8989 file must neither be compressed nor be a symbolic link.
8990 </p>
8993 In addition, the copyright file must say where the upstream
8994 sources (if any) were obtained. It should name the original
8995 authors of the package and the Debian maintainer(s) who were
8996 involved with its creation.
8997 </p>
9000 Packages in the <em>contrib</em> or <em>non-free</em> archive
9001 areas should state in the copyright file that the package is not
9002 part of the Debian GNU/Linux distribution and briefly explain
9003 why.
9004 </p>
9007 A copy of the file which will be installed in
9008 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file> should
9009 be in <file>debian/copyright</file> in the source package.
9010 </p>
9013 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> may be a symbolic
9014 link to another directory in <file>/usr/share/doc</file> only if
9015 the two packages both come from the same source and the
9016 first package Depends on the second. These rules are
9017 important because copyrights must be extractable by
9018 mechanical means.
9019 </p>
9022 Packages distributed under the UCB BSD license, the Apache
9023 license (version 2.0), the Artistic license, the GNU GPL
9024 (version 2 or 3), the GNU LGPL (versions 2, 2.1, or 3), and the
9025 GNU FDL (versions 1.2 or 1.3) should refer to the corresponding
9026 files under <file>/usr/share/common-licenses</file>,<footnote>
9028 In particular,
9029 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/BSD</file>,
9030 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/Apache-2.0</file>,
9031 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/Artistic</file>,
9032 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-2</file>,
9033 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-3</file>,
9034 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-2</file>,
9035 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-2.1</file>,
9036 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-3</file>,
9037 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GFDL-1.2</file>, and
9038 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GFDL-1.3</file>
9039 respectively.
9040 </p>
9041 </footnote> rather than quoting them in the copyright
9042 file.
9043 </p>
9046 You should not use the copyright file as a general <file>README</file>
9047 file. If your package has such a file it should be
9048 installed in <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/README</file> or
9049 <file>README.Debian</file> or some other appropriate place.</p>
9050 </sect>
9052 <sect>
9053 <heading>Examples</heading>
9056 Any examples (configurations, source files, whatever),
9057 should be installed in a directory
9058 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file>. These
9059 files should not be referenced by any program: they're there
9060 for the benefit of the system administrator and users as
9061 documentation only. Architecture-specific example files
9062 should be installed in a directory
9063 <file>/usr/lib/<var>package</var>/examples</file> with symbolic
9064 links to them from
9065 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file>, or the
9066 latter directory itself may be a symbolic link to the
9067 former.
9068 </p>
9071 If the purpose of a package is to provide examples, then the
9072 example files may be installed into
9073 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>.
9074 </p>
9075 </sect>
9077 <sect id="changelogs">
9078 <heading>Changelog files</heading>
9081 Packages that are not Debian-native must contain a
9082 compressed copy of the <file>debian/changelog</file> file from
9083 the Debian source tree in
9084 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> with the name
9085 <file>changelog.Debian.gz</file>.
9086 </p>
9089 If an upstream changelog is available, it should be accessible as
9090 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.gz</file> in
9091 plain text. If the upstream changelog is distributed in
9092 HTML, it should be made available in that form as
9093 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.html.gz</file>
9094 and a plain text <file>changelog.gz</file> should be generated
9095 from it using, for example, <tt>lynx -dump -nolist</tt>. If
9096 the upstream changelog files do not already conform to this
9097 naming convention, then this may be achieved either by
9098 renaming the files, or by adding a symbolic link, at the
9099 maintainer's discretion.<footnote>
9100 Rationale: People should not have to look in places for
9101 upstream changelogs merely because they are given
9102 different names or are distributed in HTML format.
9103 </footnote>
9104 </p>
9107 All of these files should be installed compressed using
9108 <tt>gzip -9</tt>, as they will become large with time even
9109 if they start out small.
9110 </p>
9113 If the package has only one changelog which is used both as
9114 the Debian changelog and the upstream one because there is
9115 no separate upstream maintainer then that changelog should
9116 usually be installed as
9117 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.gz</file>; if
9118 there is a separate upstream maintainer, but no upstream
9119 changelog, then the Debian changelog should still be called
9120 <file>changelog.Debian.gz</file>.
9121 </p>
9124 For details about the format and contents of the Debian
9125 changelog file, please see <ref id="dpkgchangelog">.
9126 </p>
9127 </sect>
9128 </chapt>
9130 <appendix id="pkg-scope">
9131 <heading>Introduction and scope of these appendices</heading>
9134 These appendices are taken essentially verbatim from the
9135 now-deprecated Packaging Manual, version 3.2.1.0. They are
9136 the chapters which are likely to be of use to package
9137 maintainers and which have not already been included in the
9138 policy document itself. Most of these sections are very likely
9139 not relevant to policy; they should be treated as
9140 documentation for the packaging system. Please note that these
9141 appendices are included for convenience, and for historical
9142 reasons: they used to be part of policy package, and they have
9143 not yet been incorporated into dpkg documentation. However,
9144 they still have value, and hence they are presented here.
9145 </p>
9148 They have not yet been checked to ensure that they are
9149 compatible with the contents of policy, and if there are any
9150 contradictions, the version in the main policy document takes
9151 precedence. The remaining chapters of the old Packaging
9152 Manual have also not been read in detail to ensure that there
9153 are not parts which have been left out. Both of these will be
9154 done in due course.
9155 </p>
9158 Certain parts of the Packaging manual were integrated into the
9159 Policy Manual proper, and removed from the appendices. Links
9160 have been placed from the old locations to the new ones.
9161 </p>
9164 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> is a suite of programs for creating binary
9165 package files and installing and removing them on Unix
9166 systems.<footnote>
9167 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> is targeted primarily at Debian
9168 GNU/Linux, but may work on or be ported to other
9169 systems.
9170 </footnote>
9171 </p>
9174 The binary packages are designed for the management of
9175 installed executable programs (usually compiled binaries) and
9176 their associated data, though source code examples and
9177 documentation are provided as part of some packages.</p>
9180 This manual describes the technical aspects of creating Debian
9181 binary packages (<file>.deb</file> files). It documents the
9182 behavior of the package management programs
9183 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>, <prgn>dselect</prgn> et al. and the way
9184 they interact with packages.</p>
9187 It also documents the interaction between
9188 <prgn>dselect</prgn>'s core and the access method scripts it
9189 uses to actually install the selected packages, and describes
9190 how to create a new access method.</p>
9193 This manual does not go into detail about the options and
9194 usage of the package building and installation tools. It
9195 should therefore be read in conjunction with those programs'
9196 man pages.
9197 </p>
9200 The utility programs which are provided with <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
9201 for managing various system configuration and similar issues,
9202 such as <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> and
9203 <prgn>install-info</prgn>, are not described in detail here -
9204 please see their man pages.
9205 </p>
9208 It is assumed that the reader is reasonably familiar with the
9209 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> System Administrators' manual.
9210 Unfortunately this manual does not yet exist.
9211 </p>
9214 The Debian version of the FSF's GNU hello program is provided
9215 as an example for people wishing to create Debian
9216 packages. The Debian <prgn>debmake</prgn> package is
9217 recommended as a very helpful tool in creating and maintaining
9218 Debian packages. However, while the tools and examples are
9219 helpful, they do not replace the need to read and follow the
9220 Policy and Programmer's Manual.</p>
9221 </appendix>
9223 <appendix id="pkg-binarypkg">
9224 <heading>Binary packages (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
9227 The binary package has two main sections. The first part
9228 consists of various control information files and scripts used
9229 by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when installing and removing. See <ref
9230 id="pkg-controlarea">.
9231 </p>
9234 The second part is an archive containing the files and
9235 directories to be installed.
9236 </p>
9239 In the future binary packages may also contain other
9240 components, such as checksums and digital signatures. The
9241 format for the archive is described in full in the
9242 <file>deb(5)</file> man page.
9243 </p>
9246 <sect id="pkg-bincreating"><heading>Creating package files -
9247 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn>
9248 </heading>
9251 All manipulation of binary package files is done by
9252 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn>; it's the only program that has
9253 knowledge of the format. (<prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> may be
9254 invoked by calling <prgn>dpkg</prgn>, as <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
9255 will spot that the options requested are appropriate to
9256 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> and invoke that instead with the same
9257 arguments.)
9258 </p>
9261 In order to create a binary package you must make a
9262 directory tree which contains all the files and directories
9263 you want to have in the file system data part of the package.
9264 In Debian-format source packages this directory is usually
9265 <file>debian/tmp</file>, relative to the top of the package's
9266 source tree.
9267 </p>
9270 They should have the locations (relative to the root of the
9271 directory tree you're constructing) ownerships and
9272 permissions which you want them to have on the system when
9273 they are installed.
9274 </p>
9277 With current versions of <prgn>dpkg</prgn> the uid/username
9278 and gid/groupname mappings for the users and groups being
9279 used should be the same on the system where the package is
9280 built and the one where it is installed.
9281 </p>
9284 You need to add one special directory to the root of the
9285 miniature file system tree you're creating:
9286 <prgn>DEBIAN</prgn>. It should contain the control
9287 information files, notably the binary package control file
9288 (see <ref id="pkg-controlfile">).
9289 </p>
9292 The <prgn>DEBIAN</prgn> directory will not appear in the
9293 file system archive of the package, and so won't be installed
9294 by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when the package is installed.
9295 </p>
9298 When you've prepared the package, you should invoke:
9299 <example>
9300 dpkg --build <var>directory</var>
9301 </example>
9302 </p>
9305 This will build the package in
9306 <file><var>directory</var>.deb</file>. (<prgn>dpkg</prgn> knows
9307 that <tt>--build</tt> is a <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> option, so
9308 it invokes <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> with the same arguments to
9309 build the package.)
9310 </p>
9313 See the man page <manref name="dpkg-deb" section="8"> for details of how
9314 to examine the contents of this newly-created file. You may find the
9315 output of following commands enlightening:
9316 <example>
9317 dpkg-deb --info <var>filename</var>.deb
9318 dpkg-deb --contents <var>filename</var>.deb
9319 dpkg --contents <var>filename</var>.deb
9320 </example>
9321 To view the copyright file for a package you could use this command:
9322 <example>
9323 dpkg --fsys-tarfile <var>filename</var>.deb | tar xOf - --wildcards \*/copyright | pager
9324 </example>
9325 </p>
9326 </sect>
9328 <sect id="pkg-controlarea">
9329 <heading>Package control information files</heading>
9332 The control information portion of a binary package is a
9333 collection of files with names known to <prgn>dpkg</prgn>.
9334 It will treat the contents of these files specially - some
9335 of them contain information used by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when
9336 installing or removing the package; others are scripts which
9337 the package maintainer wants <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to run.
9338 </p>
9341 It is possible to put other files in the package control
9342 area, but this is not generally a good idea (though they
9343 will largely be ignored).
9344 </p>
9347 Here is a brief list of the control info files supported by
9348 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> and a summary of what they're used for.
9349 </p>
9352 <taglist>
9353 <tag><tt>control</tt>
9354 <item>
9356 This is the key description file used by
9357 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. It specifies the package's name
9358 and version, gives its description for the user,
9359 states its relationships with other packages, and so
9360 forth. See <ref id="sourcecontrolfiles"> and
9361 <ref id="binarycontrolfiles">.
9362 </p>
9365 It is usually generated automatically from information
9366 in the source package by the
9367 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> program, and with
9368 assistance from <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>.
9369 See <ref id="pkg-sourcetools">.
9370 </p>
9371 </item>
9373 <tag><tt>postinst</tt>, <tt>preinst</tt>, <tt>postrm</tt>,
9374 <tt>prerm</tt>
9375 </tag>
9376 <item>
9378 These are executable files (usually scripts) which
9379 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> runs during installation, upgrade
9380 and removal of packages. They allow the package to
9381 deal with matters which are particular to that package
9382 or require more complicated processing than that
9383 provided by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. Details of when and
9384 how they are called are in <ref id="maintainerscripts">.
9385 </p>
9388 It is very important to make these scripts idempotent.
9389 See <ref id="idempotency">.
9390 </p>
9393 The maintainer scripts are guaranteed to run with a
9394 controlling terminal and can interact with the user.
9395 See <ref id="controllingterminal">.
9396 </p>
9397 </item>
9399 <tag><tt>conffiles</tt>
9400 </tag>
9401 <item>
9402 This file contains a list of configuration files which
9403 are to be handled automatically by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
9404 (see <ref id="pkg-conffiles">). Note that not necessarily
9405 every configuration file should be listed here.
9406 </item>
9408 <tag><tt>shlibs</tt>
9409 </tag>
9410 <item>
9411 This file contains a list of the shared libraries
9412 supplied by the package, with dependency details for
9413 each. This is used by <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>
9414 when it determines what dependencies are required in a
9415 package control file. The <tt>shlibs</tt> file format
9416 is described on <ref id="shlibs">.
9417 </item>
9418 </taglist>
9419 </p>
9421 <sect id="pkg-controlfile">
9422 <heading>The main control information file: <tt>control</tt></heading>
9425 The most important control information file used by
9426 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when it installs a package is
9427 <tt>control</tt>. It contains all the package's "vital
9428 statistics".
9429 </p>
9432 The binary package control files of packages built from
9433 Debian sources are made by a special tool,
9434 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>, which reads
9435 <file>debian/control</file> and <file>debian/changelog</file> to
9436 find the information it needs. See <ref id="pkg-sourcepkg"> for
9437 more details.
9438 </p>
9441 The fields in binary package control files are listed in
9442 <ref id="binarycontrolfiles">.
9443 </p>
9446 A description of the syntax of control files and the purpose
9447 of the fields is available in <ref id="controlfields">.
9448 </p>
9449 </sect>
9451 <sect>
9452 <heading>Time Stamps</heading>
9455 See <ref id="timestamps">.
9456 </p>
9457 </sect>
9458 </appendix>
9460 <appendix id="pkg-sourcepkg">
9461 <heading>Source packages (from old Packaging Manual) </heading>
9464 The Debian binary packages in the distribution are generated
9465 from Debian sources, which are in a special format to assist
9466 the easy and automatic building of binaries.
9467 </p>
9469 <sect id="pkg-sourcetools">
9470 <heading>Tools for processing source packages</heading>
9473 Various tools are provided for manipulating source packages;
9474 they pack and unpack sources and help build of binary
9475 packages and help manage the distribution of new versions.
9476 </p>
9479 They are introduced and typical uses described here; see
9480 <manref name="dpkg-source" section="1"> for full
9481 documentation about their arguments and operation.
9482 </p>
9485 For examples of how to construct a Debian source package,
9486 and how to use those utilities that are used by Debian
9487 source packages, please see the <prgn>hello</prgn> example
9488 package.
9489 </p>
9491 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-source">
9492 <heading>
9493 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> - packs and unpacks Debian source
9494 packages
9495 </heading>
9498 This program is frequently used by hand, and is also
9499 called from package-independent automated building scripts
9500 such as <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>.
9501 </p>
9504 To unpack a package it is typically invoked with
9505 <example>
9506 dpkg-source -x <var>.../path/to/filename</var>.dsc
9507 </example>
9508 </p>
9511 with the <file><var>filename</var>.tar.gz</file> and
9512 <file><var>filename</var>.diff.gz</file> (if applicable) in
9513 the same directory. It unpacks into
9514 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>, and if
9515 applicable
9516 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var>.orig</file>, in
9517 the current directory.
9518 </p>
9521 To create a packed source archive it is typically invoked:
9522 <example>
9523 dpkg-source -b <var>package</var>-<var>version</var>
9524 </example>
9525 </p>
9528 This will create the <file>.dsc</file>, <file>.tar.gz</file> and
9529 <file>.diff.gz</file> (if appropriate) in the current
9530 directory. <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> does not clean the
9531 source tree first - this must be done separately if it is
9532 required.
9533 </p>
9536 See also <ref id="pkg-sourcearchives">.</p>
9537 </sect1>
9540 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-buildpackage">
9541 <heading>
9542 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> - overall package-building
9543 control script
9544 </heading>
9547 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> is a script which invokes
9548 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>, the <file>debian/rules</file>
9549 targets <tt>clean</tt>, <tt>build</tt> and
9550 <tt>binary</tt>, <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> and
9551 <prgn>gpg</prgn> (or <prgn>pgp</prgn>) to build a signed
9552 source and binary package upload.
9553 </p>
9556 It is usually invoked by hand from the top level of the
9557 built or unbuilt source directory. It may be invoked with
9558 no arguments; useful arguments include:
9559 <taglist compact="compact">
9560 <tag><tt>-uc</tt>, <tt>-us</tt></tag>
9561 <item>
9563 Do not sign the <tt>.changes</tt> file or the
9564 source package <tt>.dsc</tt> file, respectively.</p>
9565 </item>
9566 <tag><tt>-p<var>sign-command</var></tt></tag>
9567 <item>
9569 Invoke <var>sign-command</var> instead of finding
9570 <tt>gpg</tt> or <tt>pgp</tt> on the <prgn>PATH</prgn>.
9571 <var>sign-command</var> must behave just like
9572 <prgn>gpg</prgn> or <tt>pgp</tt>.</p>
9573 </item>
9574 <tag><tt>-r<var>root-command</var></tt></tag>
9575 <item>
9577 When root privilege is required, invoke the command
9578 <var>root-command</var>. <var>root-command</var>
9579 should invoke its first argument as a command, from
9580 the <prgn>PATH</prgn> if necessary, and pass its
9581 second and subsequent arguments to the command it
9582 calls. If no <var>root-command</var> is supplied
9583 then <var>dpkg-buildpackage</var> will take no
9584 special action to gain root privilege, so that for
9585 most packages it will have to be invoked as root to
9586 start with.</p>
9587 </item>
9588 <tag><tt>-b</tt>, <tt>-B</tt></tag>
9589 <item>
9591 Two types of binary-only build and upload - see
9592 <manref name="dpkg-source" section="1">.
9593 </p>
9594 </item>
9595 </taglist>
9596 </p>
9597 </sect1>
9599 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-gencontrol">
9600 <heading>
9601 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> - generates binary package
9602 control files
9603 </heading>
9606 This program is usually called from <file>debian/rules</file>
9607 (see <ref id="pkg-sourcetree">) in the top level of the source
9608 tree.
9609 </p>
9612 This is usually done just before the files and directories in the
9613 temporary directory tree where the package is being built have their
9614 permissions and ownerships set and the package is constructed using
9615 <prgn>dpkg-deb/</prgn>
9616 <footnote>
9617 This is so that the control file which is produced has
9618 the right permissions
9619 </footnote>.
9620 </p>
9623 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> must be called after all the
9624 files which are to go into the package have been placed in
9625 the temporary build directory, so that its calculation of
9626 the installed size of a package is correct.
9627 </p>
9630 It is also necessary for <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
9631 be run after <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> so that the
9632 variable substitutions created by
9633 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> in <file>debian/substvars</file>
9634 are available.
9635 </p>
9638 For a package which generates only one binary package, and
9639 which builds it in <file>debian/tmp</file> relative to the top
9640 of the source package, it is usually sufficient to call
9641 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>.
9642 </p>
9645 Sources which build several binaries will typically need
9646 something like:
9647 <example>
9648 dpkg-gencontrol -Pdebian/tmp-<var>pkg</var> -p<var>package</var>
9649 </example> The <tt>-P</tt> tells
9650 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> that the package is being
9651 built in a non-default directory, and the <tt>-p</tt>
9652 tells it which package's control file should be generated.
9653 </p>
9656 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> also adds information to the
9657 list of files in <file>debian/files</file>, for the benefit of
9658 (for example) a future invocation of
9659 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn>.</p>
9660 </sect1>
9662 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps">
9663 <heading>
9664 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> - calculates shared library
9665 dependencies
9666 </heading>
9669 This program is usually called from <file>debian/rules</file>
9670 just before <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> (see <ref
9671 id="pkg-sourcetree">), in the top level of the source tree.
9672 </p>
9675 Its arguments are executables and shared libraries
9676 <footnote>
9678 They may be specified either in the locations in the
9679 source tree where they are created or in the locations
9680 in the temporary build tree where they are installed
9681 prior to binary package creation.
9682 </p>
9683 </footnote> for which shared library dependencies should
9684 be included in the binary package's control file.
9685 </p>
9688 If some of the found shared libraries should only
9689 warrant a <tt>Recommends</tt> or <tt>Suggests</tt>, or if
9690 some warrant a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>, this can be achieved
9691 by using the <tt>-d<var>dependency-field</var></tt> option
9692 before those executable(s). (Each <tt>-d</tt> option
9693 takes effect until the next <tt>-d</tt>.)
9694 </p>
9697 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> does not directly cause the
9698 output control file to be modified. Instead by default it
9699 adds to the <file>debian/substvars</file> file variable
9700 settings like <tt>shlibs:Depends</tt>. These variable
9701 settings must be referenced in dependency fields in the
9702 appropriate per-binary-package sections of the source
9703 control file.
9704 </p>
9707 For example, a package that generates an essential part
9708 which requires dependencies, and optional parts that
9709 which only require a recommendation, would separate those
9710 two sets of dependencies into two different fields.<footnote>
9711 At the time of writing, an example for this was the
9712 <package/xmms/ package, with Depends used for the xmms
9713 executable, Recommends for the plug-ins and Suggests for
9714 even more optional features provided by unzip.
9715 </footnote>
9716 It can say in its <file>debian/rules</file>:
9717 <example>
9718 dpkg-shlibdeps -dDepends <var>program anotherprogram ...</var> \
9719 -dRecommends <var>optionalpart anotheroptionalpart</var>
9720 </example>
9721 and then in its main control file <file>debian/control</file>:
9722 <example>
9723 <var>...</var>
9724 Depends: ${shlibs:Depends}
9725 Recommends: ${shlibs:Recommends}
9726 <var>...</var>
9727 </example>
9728 </p>
9731 Sources which produce several binary packages with
9732 different shared library dependency requirements can use
9733 the <tt>-p<var>varnameprefix</var></tt> option to override
9734 the default <tt>shlibs:</tt> prefix (one invocation of
9735 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> per setting of this option).
9736 They can thus produce several sets of dependency
9737 variables, each of the form
9738 <tt><var>varnameprefix</var>:<var>dependencyfield</var></tt>,
9739 which can be referred to in the appropriate parts of the
9740 binary package control files.
9741 </p>
9742 </sect1>
9745 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-distaddfile">
9746 <heading>
9747 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> - adds a file to
9748 <file>debian/files</file>
9749 </heading>
9752 Some packages' uploads need to include files other than
9753 the source and binary package files.
9754 </p>
9757 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> adds a file to the
9758 <file>debian/files</file> file so that it will be included in
9759 the <file>.changes</file> file when
9760 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> is run.
9761 </p>
9764 It is usually invoked from the <tt>binary</tt> target of
9765 <file>debian/rules</file>:
9766 <example>
9767 dpkg-distaddfile <var>filename</var> <var>section</var> <var>priority</var>
9768 </example>
9769 The <var>filename</var> is relative to the directory where
9770 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> will expect to find it - this
9771 is usually the directory above the top level of the source
9772 tree. The <file>debian/rules</file> target should put the
9773 file there just before or just after calling
9774 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn>.
9775 </p>
9778 The <var>section</var> and <var>priority</var> are passed
9779 unchanged into the resulting <file>.changes</file> file.
9780 </p>
9781 </sect1>
9784 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-genchanges">
9785 <heading>
9786 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> - generates a <file>.changes</file>
9787 upload control file
9788 </heading>
9791 This program is usually called by package-independent
9792 automatic building scripts such as
9793 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>, but it may also be called
9794 by hand.
9795 </p>
9798 It is usually called in the top level of a built source
9799 tree, and when invoked with no arguments will print out a
9800 straightforward <file>.changes</file> file based on the
9801 information in the source package's changelog and control
9802 file and the binary and source packages which should have
9803 been built.
9804 </p>
9805 </sect1>
9808 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-parsechangelog">
9809 <heading>
9810 <prgn>dpkg-parsechangelog</prgn> - produces parsed
9811 representation of a changelog
9812 </heading>
9815 This program is used internally by
9816 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> et al. It may also occasionally
9817 be useful in <file>debian/rules</file> and elsewhere. It
9818 parses a changelog, <file>debian/changelog</file> by default,
9819 and prints a control-file format representation of the
9820 information in it to standard output.
9821 </p>
9822 </sect1>
9824 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-architecture">
9825 <heading>
9826 <prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn> - information about the build and
9827 host system
9828 </heading>
9831 This program can be used manually, but is also invoked by
9832 <tt>dpkg-buildpackage</tt> or <file>debian/rules</file> to set
9833 environment or make variables which specify the build and host
9834 architecture for the package building process.
9835 </p>
9836 </sect1>
9837 </sect>
9839 <sect id="pkg-sourcetree">
9840 <heading>The Debianised source tree</heading>
9843 The source archive scheme described later is intended to
9844 allow a Debianised source tree with some associated control
9845 information to be reproduced and transported easily. The
9846 Debianised source tree is a version of the original program
9847 with certain files added for the benefit of the
9848 Debianisation process, and with any other changes required
9849 made to the rest of the source code and installation
9850 scripts.
9851 </p>
9854 The extra files created for Debian are in the subdirectory
9855 <file>debian</file> of the top level of the Debianised source
9856 tree. They are described below.
9857 </p>
9859 <sect1 id="pkg-debianrules">
9860 <heading><file>debian/rules</file> - the main building script</heading>
9863 See <ref id="debianrules">.
9864 </p>
9865 </sect1>
9868 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkgchangelog">
9869 <heading><file>debian/changelog</file></heading>
9872 See <ref id="dpkgchangelog">.
9873 </p>
9875 <sect2><heading>Defining alternative changelog formats
9876 </heading>
9879 It is possible to use a different format to the standard
9880 one, by providing a parser for the format you wish to
9881 use.
9882 </p>
9885 In order to have <tt>dpkg-parsechangelog</tt> run your
9886 parser, you must include a line within the last 40 lines
9887 of your file matching the Perl regular expression:
9888 <tt>\schangelog-format:\s+([0-9a-z]+)\W</tt> The part in
9889 parentheses should be the name of the format. For
9890 example, you might say:
9891 <example>
9892 @@@ changelog-format: joebloggs @@@
9893 </example>
9894 Changelog format names are non-empty strings of alphanumerics.
9895 </p>
9898 If such a line exists then <tt>dpkg-parsechangelog</tt>
9899 will look for the parser as
9900 <file>/usr/lib/dpkg/parsechangelog/<var>format-name</var></file>
9902 <file>/usr/local/lib/dpkg/parsechangelog/<var>format-name</var></file>;
9903 it is an error for it not to find it, or for it not to
9904 be an executable program. The default changelog format
9905 is <tt>dpkg</tt>, and a parser for it is provided with
9906 the <tt>dpkg</tt> package.
9907 </p>
9910 The parser will be invoked with the changelog open on
9911 standard input at the start of the file. It should read
9912 the file (it may seek if it wishes) to determine the
9913 information required and return the parsed information
9914 to standard output in the form of a series of control
9915 fields in the standard format. By default it should
9916 return information about only the most recent version in
9917 the changelog; it should accept a
9918 <tt>-v<var>version</var></tt> option to return changes
9919 information from all versions present <em>strictly
9920 after</em> <var>version</var>, and it should then be an
9921 error for <var>version</var> not to be present in the
9922 changelog.
9923 </p>
9926 The fields are:
9927 <list compact="compact">
9928 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref></item>
9929 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
9930 <item><qref id="f-Distribution"><tt>Distribution</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
9931 <item><qref id="f-Urgency"><tt>Urgency</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
9932 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
9933 <item><qref id="f-Date"><tt>Date</tt></qref></item>
9934 <item><qref id="f-Changes"><tt>Changes</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
9935 </list>
9936 </p>
9939 If several versions are being returned (due to the use
9940 of <tt>-v</tt>), the urgency value should be of the
9941 highest urgency code listed at the start of any of the
9942 versions requested followed by the concatenated
9943 (space-separated) comments from all the versions
9944 requested; the maintainer, version, distribution and
9945 date should always be from the most recent version.
9946 </p>
9949 For the format of the <tt>Changes</tt> field see
9950 <ref id="f-Changes">.
9951 </p>
9954 If the changelog format which is being parsed always or
9955 almost always leaves a blank line between individual
9956 change notes these blank lines should be stripped out,
9957 so as to make the resulting output compact.
9958 </p>
9961 If the changelog format does not contain date or package
9962 name information this information should be omitted from
9963 the output. The parser should not attempt to synthesize
9964 it or find it from other sources.
9965 </p>
9968 If the changelog does not have the expected format the
9969 parser should exit with a nonzero exit status, rather
9970 than trying to muddle through and possibly generating
9971 incorrect output.
9972 </p>
9975 A changelog parser may not interact with the user at
9976 all.
9977 </p>
9978 </sect2>
9979 </sect1>
9981 <sect1 id="pkg-srcsubstvars">
9982 <heading><file>debian/substvars</file> and variable substitutions</heading>
9985 See <ref id="substvars">.
9986 </p>
9988 </sect1>
9990 <sect1>
9991 <heading><file>debian/files</file></heading>
9994 See <ref id="debianfiles">.
9995 </p>
9996 </sect1>
9998 <sect1><heading><file>debian/tmp</file>
9999 </heading>
10002 This is the canonical temporary location for the
10003 construction of binary packages by the <tt>binary</tt>
10004 target. The directory <file>tmp</file> serves as the root of
10005 the file system tree as it is being constructed (for
10006 example, by using the package's upstream makefiles install
10007 targets and redirecting the output there), and it also
10008 contains the <tt>DEBIAN</tt> subdirectory. See <ref
10009 id="pkg-bincreating">.
10010 </p>
10013 If several binary packages are generated from the same
10014 source tree it is usual to use several
10015 <file>debian/tmp<var>something</var></file> directories, for
10016 example <file>tmp-a</file> or <file>tmp-doc</file>.
10017 </p>
10020 Whatever <file>tmp</file> directories are created and used by
10021 <tt>binary</tt> must of course be removed by the
10022 <tt>clean</tt> target.</p></sect1>
10023 </sect>
10026 <sect id="pkg-sourcearchives"><heading>Source packages as archives
10027 </heading>
10030 As it exists on the FTP site, a Debian source package
10031 consists of three related files. You must have the right
10032 versions of all three to be able to use them.
10033 </p>
10036 <taglist>
10037 <tag>Debian source control file - <tt>.dsc</tt></tag>
10038 <item>
10039 This file is a control file used by <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
10040 to extract a source package.
10041 See <ref id="debiansourcecontrolfiles">.
10042 </item>
10044 <tag>
10045 Original source archive -
10046 <file>
10047 <var>package</var>_<var>upstream-version</var>.orig.tar.gz
10048 </file>
10049 </tag>
10051 <item>
10053 This is a compressed (with <tt>gzip -9</tt>)
10054 <prgn>tar</prgn> file containing the source code from
10055 the upstream authors of the program.
10056 </p>
10057 </item>
10059 <tag>
10060 Debianisation diff -
10061 <file>
10062 <var>package</var>_<var>upstream_version-revision</var>.diff.gz
10063 </file>
10064 </tag>
10065 <item>
10068 This is a unified context diff (<tt>diff -u</tt>)
10069 giving the changes which are required to turn the
10070 original source into the Debian source. These changes
10071 may only include editing and creating plain files.
10072 The permissions of files, the targets of symbolic
10073 links and the characteristics of special files or
10074 pipes may not be changed and no files may be removed
10075 or renamed.
10076 </p>
10079 All the directories in the diff must exist, except the
10080 <file>debian</file> subdirectory of the top of the source
10081 tree, which will be created by
10082 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> if necessary when unpacking.
10083 </p>
10086 The <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> program will
10087 automatically make the <file>debian/rules</file> file
10088 executable (see below).</p></item>
10089 </taglist>
10090 </p>
10093 If there is no original source code - for example, if the
10094 package is specially prepared for Debian or the Debian
10095 maintainer is the same as the upstream maintainer - the
10096 format is slightly different: then there is no diff, and the
10097 tarfile is named
10098 <file><var>package</var>_<var>version</var>.tar.gz</file>,
10099 and preferably contains a directory named
10100 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>.
10101 </p>
10102 </sect>
10104 <sect>
10105 <heading>Unpacking a Debian source package without <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn></heading>
10108 <tt>dpkg-source -x</tt> is the recommended way to unpack a
10109 Debian source package. However, if it is not available it
10110 is possible to unpack a Debian source archive as follows:
10111 <enumlist compact="compact">
10112 <item>
10114 Untar the tarfile, which will create a <file>.orig</file>
10115 directory.</p>
10116 </item>
10117 <item>
10118 <p>Rename the <file>.orig</file> directory to
10119 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>.</p>
10120 </item>
10121 <item>
10123 Create the subdirectory <file>debian</file> at the top of
10124 the source tree.</p>
10125 </item>
10126 <item><p>Apply the diff using <tt>patch -p0</tt>.</p>
10127 </item>
10128 <item><p>Untar the tarfile again if you want a copy of the original
10129 source code alongside the Debianised version.</p>
10130 </item>
10131 </enumlist>
10134 It is not possible to generate a valid Debian source archive
10135 without using <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>. In particular,
10136 attempting to use <prgn>diff</prgn> directly to generate the
10137 <file>.diff.gz</file> file will not work.
10138 </p>
10140 <sect1>
10141 <heading>Restrictions on objects in source packages</heading>
10144 The source package may not contain any hard links
10145 <footnote>
10146 This is not currently detected when building source
10147 packages, but only when extracting
10148 them.
10149 </footnote>
10150 <footnote>
10151 Hard links may be permitted at some point in the
10152 future, but would require a fair amount of
10153 work.
10154 </footnote>, device special files, sockets or setuid or
10155 setgid files.
10156 <footnote>
10157 Setgid directories are allowed.
10158 </footnote>
10159 </p>
10162 The source packaging tools manage the changes between the
10163 original and Debianised source using <prgn>diff</prgn> and
10164 <prgn>patch</prgn>. Turning the original source tree as
10165 included in the <file>.orig.tar.gz</file> into the debianised
10166 source must not involve any changes which cannot be
10167 handled by these tools. Problematic changes which cause
10168 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> to halt with an error when
10169 building the source package are:
10170 <list compact="compact">
10171 <item><p>Adding or removing symbolic links, sockets or pipes.</p>
10172 </item>
10173 <item><p>Changing the targets of symbolic links.</p>
10174 </item>
10175 <item><p>Creating directories, other than <file>debian</file>.</p>
10176 </item>
10177 <item><p>Changes to the contents of binary files.</p></item>
10178 </list> Changes which cause <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> to
10179 print a warning but continue anyway are:
10180 <list compact="compact">
10181 <item>
10183 Removing files, directories or symlinks.
10184 <footnote>
10185 Renaming a file is not treated specially - it is
10186 seen as the removal of the old file (which
10187 generates a warning, but is otherwise ignored),
10188 and the creation of the new one.
10189 </footnote>
10190 </p>
10191 </item>
10192 <item>
10194 Changed text files which are missing the usual final
10195 newline (either in the original or the modified
10196 source tree).
10197 </p>
10198 </item>
10199 </list>
10200 Changes which are not represented, but which are not detected by
10201 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>, are:
10202 <list compact="compact">
10203 <item><p>Changing the permissions of files (other than
10204 <file>debian/rules</file>) and directories.</p></item>
10205 </list>
10206 </p>
10209 The <file>debian</file> directory and <file>debian/rules</file>
10210 are handled specially by <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> - before
10211 applying the changes it will create the <file>debian</file>
10212 directory, and afterwards it will make
10213 <file>debian/rules</file> world-executable.
10214 </p>
10215 </sect1>
10216 </sect>
10217 </appendix>
10219 <appendix id="pkg-controlfields">
10220 <heading>Control files and their fields (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
10223 Many of the tools in the <prgn>dpkg</prgn> suite manipulate
10224 data in a common format, known as control files. Binary and
10225 source packages have control data as do the <file>.changes</file>
10226 files which control the installation of uploaded files, and
10227 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s internal databases are in a similar
10228 format.
10229 </p>
10231 <sect>
10232 <heading>Syntax of control files</heading>
10235 See <ref id="controlsyntax">.
10236 </p>
10239 It is important to note that there are several fields which
10240 are optional as far as <prgn>dpkg</prgn> and the related
10241 tools are concerned, but which must appear in every Debian
10242 package, or whose omission may cause problems.
10243 </p>
10244 </sect>
10246 <sect>
10247 <heading>List of fields</heading>
10250 See <ref id="controlfieldslist">.
10251 </p>
10254 This section now contains only the fields that didn't belong
10255 to the Policy manual.
10256 </p>
10258 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Filename">
10259 <heading><tt>Filename</tt> and <tt>MSDOS-Filename</tt></heading>
10262 These fields in <tt>Packages</tt> files give the
10263 filename(s) of (the parts of) a package in the
10264 distribution directories, relative to the root of the
10265 Debian hierarchy. If the package has been split into
10266 several parts the parts are all listed in order, separated
10267 by spaces.
10268 </p>
10269 </sect1>
10271 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Size">
10272 <heading><tt>Size</tt> and <tt>MD5sum</tt></heading>
10275 These fields in <file>Packages</file> files give the size (in
10276 bytes, expressed in decimal) and MD5 checksum of the
10277 file(s) which make(s) up a binary package in the
10278 distribution. If the package is split into several parts
10279 the values for the parts are listed in order, separated by
10280 spaces.
10281 </p>
10282 </sect1>
10284 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Status">
10285 <heading><tt>Status</tt></heading>
10288 This field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file records
10289 whether the user wants a package installed, removed or
10290 left alone, whether it is broken (requiring
10291 re-installation) or not and what its current state on the
10292 system is. Each of these pieces of information is a
10293 single word.
10294 </p>
10295 </sect1>
10297 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Config-Version">
10298 <heading><tt>Config-Version</tt></heading>
10301 If a package is not installed or not configured, this
10302 field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file records the last
10303 version of the package which was successfully
10304 configured.
10305 </p>
10306 </sect1>
10308 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Conffiles">
10309 <heading><tt>Conffiles</tt></heading>
10312 This field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file contains
10313 information about the automatically-managed configuration
10314 files held by a package. This field should <em>not</em>
10315 appear anywhere in a package!
10316 </p>
10317 </sect1>
10319 <sect1>
10320 <heading>Obsolete fields</heading>
10323 These are still recognized by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> but should
10324 not appear anywhere any more.
10326 <taglist compact="compact">
10328 <tag><tt>Revision</tt></tag>
10329 <tag><tt>Package-Revision</tt></tag>
10330 <tag><tt>Package_Revision</tt></tag>
10331 <item>
10332 The Debian revision part of the package version was
10333 at one point in a separate control file field. This
10334 field went through several names.
10335 </item>
10337 <tag><tt>Recommended</tt></tag>
10338 <item>Old name for <tt>Recommends</tt>.</item>
10340 <tag><tt>Optional</tt></tag>
10341 <item>Old name for <tt>Suggests</tt>.</item>
10343 <tag><tt>Class</tt></tag>
10344 <item>Old name for <tt>Priority</tt>.</item>
10346 </taglist>
10347 </p>
10348 </sect1>
10349 </sect>
10351 </appendix>
10353 <appendix id="pkg-conffiles">
10354 <heading>Configuration file handling (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
10357 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> can do a certain amount of automatic
10358 handling of package configuration files.
10359 </p>
10362 Whether this mechanism is appropriate depends on a number of
10363 factors, but basically there are two approaches to any
10364 particular configuration file.
10365 </p>
10368 The easy method is to ship a best-effort configuration in the
10369 package, and use <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s conffile mechanism to
10370 handle updates. If the user is unlikely to want to edit the
10371 file, but you need them to be able to without losing their
10372 changes, and a new package with a changed version of the file
10373 is only released infrequently, this is a good approach.
10374 </p>
10377 The hard method is to build the configuration file from
10378 scratch in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script, and to take the
10379 responsibility for fixing any mistakes made in earlier
10380 versions of the package automatically. This will be
10381 appropriate if the file is likely to need to be different on
10382 each system.
10383 </p>
10385 <sect><heading>Automatic handling of configuration files by
10386 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
10387 </heading>
10390 A package may contain a control area file called
10391 <tt>conffiles</tt>. This file should be a list of filenames
10392 of configuration files needing automatic handling, separated
10393 by newlines. The filenames should be absolute pathnames,
10394 and the files referred to should actually exist in the
10395 package.
10396 </p>
10399 When a package is upgraded <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will process
10400 the configuration files during the configuration stage,
10401 shortly before it runs the package's <prgn>postinst</prgn>
10402 script,
10403 </p>
10406 For each file it checks to see whether the version of the
10407 file included in the package is the same as the one that was
10408 included in the last version of the package (the one that is
10409 being upgraded from); it also compares the version currently
10410 installed on the system with the one shipped with the last
10411 version.
10412 </p>
10415 If neither the user nor the package maintainer has changed
10416 the file, it is left alone. If one or the other has changed
10417 their version, then the changed version is preferred - i.e.,
10418 if the user edits their file, but the package maintainer
10419 doesn't ship a different version, the user's changes will
10420 stay, silently, but if the maintainer ships a new version
10421 and the user hasn't edited it the new version will be
10422 installed (with an informative message). If both have
10423 changed their version the user is prompted about the problem
10424 and must resolve the differences themselves.
10425 </p>
10428 The comparisons are done by calculating the MD5 message
10429 digests of the files, and storing the MD5 of the file as it
10430 was included in the most recent version of the package.
10431 </p>
10434 When a package is installed for the first time
10435 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will install the file that comes with it,
10436 unless that would mean overwriting a file already on the
10437 file system.
10438 </p>
10441 However, note that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will <em>not</em>
10442 replace a conffile that was removed by the user (or by a
10443 script). This is necessary because with some programs a
10444 missing file produces an effect hard or impossible to
10445 achieve in another way, so that a missing file needs to be
10446 kept that way if the user did it.
10447 </p>
10450 Note that a package should <em>not</em> modify a
10451 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>-handled conffile in its maintainer
10452 scripts. Doing this will lead to <prgn>dpkg</prgn> giving
10453 the user confusing and possibly dangerous options for
10454 conffile update when the package is upgraded.</p>
10455 </sect>
10457 <sect><heading>Fully-featured maintainer script configuration
10458 handling
10459 </heading>
10462 For files which contain site-specific information such as
10463 the hostname and networking details and so forth, it is
10464 better to create the file in the package's
10465 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script.
10466 </p>
10469 This will typically involve examining the state of the rest
10470 of the system to determine values and other information, and
10471 may involve prompting the user for some information which
10472 can't be obtained some other way.
10473 </p>
10476 When using this method there are a couple of important
10477 issues which should be considered:
10478 </p>
10481 If you discover a bug in the program which generates the
10482 configuration file, or if the format of the file changes
10483 from one version to the next, you will have to arrange for
10484 the postinst script to do something sensible - usually this
10485 will mean editing the installed configuration file to remove
10486 the problem or change the syntax. You will have to do this
10487 very carefully, since the user may have changed the file,
10488 perhaps to fix the very problem that your script is trying
10489 to deal with - you will have to detect these situations and
10490 deal with them correctly.
10491 </p>
10494 If you do go down this route it's probably a good idea to
10495 make the program that generates the configuration file(s) a
10496 separate program in <file>/usr/sbin</file>, by convention called
10497 <file><var>package</var>config</file> and then run that if
10498 appropriate from the post-installation script. The
10499 <tt><var>package</var>config</tt> program should not
10500 unquestioningly overwrite an existing configuration - if its
10501 mode of operation is geared towards setting up a package for
10502 the first time (rather than any arbitrary reconfiguration
10503 later) you should have it check whether the configuration
10504 already exists, and require a <tt>--force</tt> flag to
10505 overwrite it.</p></sect>
10506 </appendix>
10508 <appendix id="pkg-alternatives"><heading>Alternative versions of
10509 an interface - <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> (from old
10510 Packaging Manual)
10511 </heading>
10514 When several packages all provide different versions of the
10515 same program or file it is useful to have the system select a
10516 default, but to allow the system administrator to change it
10517 and have their decisions respected.
10518 </p>
10521 For example, there are several versions of the <prgn>vi</prgn>
10522 editor, and there is no reason to prevent all of them from
10523 being installed at once, each under their own name
10524 (<prgn>nvi</prgn>, <prgn>vim</prgn> or whatever).
10525 Nevertheless it is desirable to have the name <tt>vi</tt>
10526 refer to something, at least by default.
10527 </p>
10530 If all the packages involved cooperate, this can be done with
10531 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>.
10532 </p>
10535 Each package provides its own version under its own name, and
10536 calls <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> in its postinst to
10537 register its version (and again in its prerm to deregister
10538 it).
10539 </p>
10542 See the man page <manref name="update-alternatives"
10543 section="8"> for details.
10544 </p>
10547 If <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> does not seem appropriate
10548 you may wish to consider using diversions instead.</p>
10549 </appendix>
10551 <appendix id="pkg-diversions"><heading>Diversions - overriding a
10552 package's version of a file (from old Packaging Manual)
10553 </heading>
10556 It is possible to have <prgn>dpkg</prgn> not overwrite a file
10557 when it reinstalls the package it belongs to, and to have it
10558 put the file from the package somewhere else instead.
10559 </p>
10562 This can be used locally to override a package's version of a
10563 file, or by one package to override another's version (or
10564 provide a wrapper for it).
10565 </p>
10568 Before deciding to use a diversion, read <ref
10569 id="pkg-alternatives"> to see if you really want a diversion
10570 rather than several alternative versions of a program.
10571 </p>
10574 There is a diversion list, which is read by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>,
10575 and updated by a special program <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn>.
10576 Please see <manref name="dpkg-divert" section="8"> for full
10577 details of its operation.
10578 </p>
10581 When a package wishes to divert a file from another, it should
10582 call <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> in its preinst to add the
10583 diversion and rename the existing file. For example,
10584 supposing that a <prgn>smailwrapper</prgn> package wishes to
10585 install a wrapper around <file>/usr/sbin/smail</file>:
10586 <example>
10587 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --add --rename \
10588 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10589 </example> The <tt>--package smailwrapper</tt> ensures that
10590 <prgn>smailwrapper</prgn>'s copy of <file>/usr/sbin/smail</file>
10591 can bypass the diversion and get installed as the true version.
10592 It's safe to add the diversion unconditionally on upgrades since
10593 it will be left unchanged if it already exists, but
10594 <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> will display a message. To suppress that
10595 message, make the command conditional on the version from which
10596 the package is being upgraded:
10597 <example>
10598 if [ upgrade != "$1" ] || dpkg --compare-versions "$2" lt 1.0-2; then
10599 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --add --rename \
10600 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10602 </example> where <tt>1.0-2</tt> is the version at which the
10603 diversion was first added to the package. Running the command
10604 during abort-upgrade is pointless but harmless.
10605 </p>
10608 The postrm has to do the reverse:
10609 <example>
10610 if [ remove = "$1" -o abort-install = "$1" -o disappear = "$1" ]; then
10611 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --remove --rename \
10612 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10614 </example> If the diversion was added at a particular version, the
10615 postrm should also handle the failure case of upgrading from an
10616 older version (unless the older version is so old that direct
10617 upgrades are no longer supported):
10618 <example>
10619 if [ abort-upgrade = "$1" ] && dpkg --compare-versions "$2" lt 1.0-2; then
10620 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --remove --rename \
10621 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10623 </example> where <tt>1.02-2</tt> is the version at which the
10624 diversion was first added to the package. The postrm should not
10625 remove the diversion on upgrades both because there's no reason to
10626 remove the diversion only to immediately re-add it and since the
10627 postrm of the old package is run after unpacking so the removal of
10628 the diversion will fail.
10629 </p>
10632 Do not attempt to divert a file which is vitally important for
10633 the system's operation - when using <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn>
10634 there is a time, after it has been diverted but before
10635 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> has installed the new version, when the file
10636 does not exist.</p>
10637 </appendix>
10639 </book>
10640 </debiandoc>
10641 <!-- Local variables: -->
10642 <!-- indent-tabs-mode: t -->
10643 <!-- End: -->
10644 <!-- vim:set ai et sts=2 sw=2 tw=76: -->